* config/frv/frv-protos.h (frv_ifcvt_machdep_init): Prototype.
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / config / frv / frv.c
blobd06a4edd6b5e4beae9552d6ea54a6bdb4132387e
1 /* Copyright (C) 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
2 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Contributed by Red Hat, Inc.
5 This file is part of GCC.
7 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
19 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21 #include "config.h"
22 #include "system.h"
23 #include "coretypes.h"
24 #include "tm.h"
25 #include "rtl.h"
26 #include "tree.h"
27 #include "regs.h"
28 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
29 #include "insn-config.h"
30 #include "conditions.h"
31 #include "insn-flags.h"
32 #include "output.h"
33 #include "insn-attr.h"
34 #include "flags.h"
35 #include "recog.h"
36 #include "reload.h"
37 #include "expr.h"
38 #include "obstack.h"
39 #include "except.h"
40 #include "function.h"
41 #include "optabs.h"
42 #include "diagnostic-core.h"
43 #include "basic-block.h"
44 #include "tm_p.h"
45 #include "ggc.h"
46 #include "target.h"
47 #include "target-def.h"
48 #include "targhooks.h"
49 #include "langhooks.h"
50 #include "df.h"
51 #include "dumpfile.h"
53 #ifndef FRV_INLINE
54 #define FRV_INLINE inline
55 #endif
57 /* The maximum number of distinct NOP patterns. There are three:
58 nop, fnop and mnop. */
59 #define NUM_NOP_PATTERNS 3
61 /* Classification of instructions and units: integer, floating-point/media,
62 branch and control. */
63 enum frv_insn_group { GROUP_I, GROUP_FM, GROUP_B, GROUP_C, NUM_GROUPS };
65 /* The DFA names of the units, in packet order. */
66 static const char *const frv_unit_names[] =
68 "c",
69 "i0", "f0",
70 "i1", "f1",
71 "i2", "f2",
72 "i3", "f3",
73 "b0", "b1"
76 /* The classification of each unit in frv_unit_names[]. */
77 static const enum frv_insn_group frv_unit_groups[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names)] =
79 GROUP_C,
80 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
81 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
82 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
83 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
84 GROUP_B, GROUP_B
87 /* Return the DFA unit code associated with the Nth unit of integer
88 or floating-point group GROUP, */
89 #define NTH_UNIT(GROUP, N) frv_unit_codes[(GROUP) + (N) * 2 + 1]
91 /* Return the number of integer or floating-point unit UNIT
92 (1 for I1, 2 for F2, etc.). */
93 #define UNIT_NUMBER(UNIT) (((UNIT) - 1) / 2)
95 /* The DFA unit number for each unit in frv_unit_names[]. */
96 static int frv_unit_codes[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names)];
98 /* FRV_TYPE_TO_UNIT[T] is the last unit in frv_unit_names[] that can issue
99 an instruction of type T. The value is ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names) if
100 no instruction of type T has been seen. */
101 static unsigned int frv_type_to_unit[TYPE_UNKNOWN + 1];
103 /* An array of dummy nop INSNs, one for each type of nop that the
104 target supports. */
105 static GTY(()) rtx frv_nops[NUM_NOP_PATTERNS];
107 /* The number of nop instructions in frv_nops[]. */
108 static unsigned int frv_num_nops;
110 /* The type of access. FRV_IO_UNKNOWN means the access can be either
111 a read or a write. */
112 enum frv_io_type { FRV_IO_UNKNOWN, FRV_IO_READ, FRV_IO_WRITE };
114 /* Information about one __builtin_read or __builtin_write access, or
115 the combination of several such accesses. The most general value
116 is all-zeros (an unknown access to an unknown address). */
117 struct frv_io {
118 enum frv_io_type type;
120 /* The constant address being accessed, or zero if not known. */
121 HOST_WIDE_INT const_address;
123 /* The run-time address, as used in operand 0 of the membar pattern. */
124 rtx var_address;
127 /* Return true if instruction INSN should be packed with the following
128 instruction. */
129 #define PACKING_FLAG_P(INSN) (GET_MODE (INSN) == TImode)
131 /* Set the value of PACKING_FLAG_P(INSN). */
132 #define SET_PACKING_FLAG(INSN) PUT_MODE (INSN, TImode)
133 #define CLEAR_PACKING_FLAG(INSN) PUT_MODE (INSN, VOIDmode)
135 /* Loop with REG set to each hard register in rtx X. */
136 #define FOR_EACH_REGNO(REG, X) \
137 for (REG = REGNO (X); \
138 REG < REGNO (X) + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (X), GET_MODE (X)); \
139 REG++)
141 /* This structure contains machine specific function data. */
142 struct GTY(()) machine_function
144 /* True if we have created an rtx that relies on the stack frame. */
145 int frame_needed;
147 /* True if this function contains at least one __builtin_{read,write}*. */
148 bool has_membar_p;
151 /* Temporary register allocation support structure. */
152 typedef struct frv_tmp_reg_struct
154 HARD_REG_SET regs; /* possible registers to allocate */
155 int next_reg[N_REG_CLASSES]; /* next register to allocate per class */
157 frv_tmp_reg_t;
159 /* Register state information for VLIW re-packing phase. */
160 #define REGSTATE_CC_MASK 0x07 /* Mask to isolate CCn for cond exec */
161 #define REGSTATE_MODIFIED 0x08 /* reg modified in current VLIW insn */
162 #define REGSTATE_IF_TRUE 0x10 /* reg modified in cond exec true */
163 #define REGSTATE_IF_FALSE 0x20 /* reg modified in cond exec false */
165 #define REGSTATE_IF_EITHER (REGSTATE_IF_TRUE | REGSTATE_IF_FALSE)
167 typedef unsigned char regstate_t;
169 /* Used in frv_frame_accessor_t to indicate the direction of a register-to-
170 memory move. */
171 enum frv_stack_op
173 FRV_LOAD,
174 FRV_STORE
177 /* Information required by frv_frame_access. */
178 typedef struct
180 /* This field is FRV_LOAD if registers are to be loaded from the stack and
181 FRV_STORE if they should be stored onto the stack. FRV_STORE implies
182 the move is being done by the prologue code while FRV_LOAD implies it
183 is being done by the epilogue. */
184 enum frv_stack_op op;
186 /* The base register to use when accessing the stack. This may be the
187 frame pointer, stack pointer, or a temporary. The choice of register
188 depends on which part of the frame is being accessed and how big the
189 frame is. */
190 rtx base;
192 /* The offset of BASE from the bottom of the current frame, in bytes. */
193 int base_offset;
194 } frv_frame_accessor_t;
196 /* Conditional execution support gathered together in one structure. */
197 typedef struct
199 /* Linked list of insns to add if the conditional execution conversion was
200 successful. Each link points to an EXPR_LIST which points to the pattern
201 of the insn to add, and the insn to be inserted before. */
202 rtx added_insns_list;
204 /* Identify which registers are safe to allocate for if conversions to
205 conditional execution. We keep the last allocated register in the
206 register classes between COND_EXEC statements. This will mean we allocate
207 different registers for each different COND_EXEC group if we can. This
208 might allow the scheduler to intermix two different COND_EXEC sections. */
209 frv_tmp_reg_t tmp_reg;
211 /* For nested IFs, identify which CC registers are used outside of setting
212 via a compare isnsn, and using via a check insn. This will allow us to
213 know if we can rewrite the register to use a different register that will
214 be paired with the CR register controlling the nested IF-THEN blocks. */
215 HARD_REG_SET nested_cc_ok_rewrite;
217 /* Temporary registers allocated to hold constants during conditional
218 execution. */
219 rtx scratch_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
221 /* Current number of temp registers available. */
222 int cur_scratch_regs;
224 /* Number of nested conditional execution blocks. */
225 int num_nested_cond_exec;
227 /* Map of insns that set up constants in scratch registers. */
228 bitmap scratch_insns_bitmap;
230 /* Conditional execution test register (CC0..CC7). */
231 rtx cr_reg;
233 /* Conditional execution compare register that is paired with cr_reg, so that
234 nested compares can be done. The csubcc and caddcc instructions don't
235 have enough bits to specify both a CC register to be set and a CR register
236 to do the test on, so the same bit number is used for both. Needless to
237 say, this is rather inconvenient for GCC. */
238 rtx nested_cc_reg;
240 /* Extra CR registers used for &&, ||. */
241 rtx extra_int_cr;
242 rtx extra_fp_cr;
244 /* Previous CR used in nested if, to make sure we are dealing with the same
245 nested if as the previous statement. */
246 rtx last_nested_if_cr;
248 frv_ifcvt_t;
250 static /* GTY(()) */ frv_ifcvt_t frv_ifcvt;
252 /* Map register number to smallest register class. */
253 enum reg_class regno_reg_class[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
255 /* Cached value of frv_stack_info. */
256 static frv_stack_t *frv_stack_cache = (frv_stack_t *)0;
258 /* Forward references */
260 static void frv_option_override (void);
261 static bool frv_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode, rtx, bool);
262 static int frv_default_flags_for_cpu (void);
263 static int frv_string_begins_with (const_tree, const char *);
264 static FRV_INLINE bool frv_small_data_reloc_p (rtx, int);
265 static void frv_print_operand (FILE *, rtx, int);
266 static void frv_print_operand_address (FILE *, rtx);
267 static bool frv_print_operand_punct_valid_p (unsigned char code);
268 static void frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg
269 (FILE *, rtx);
270 static void frv_print_operand_memory_reference (FILE *, rtx, int);
271 static int frv_print_operand_jump_hint (rtx);
272 static const char *comparison_string (enum rtx_code, rtx);
273 static rtx frv_function_value (const_tree, const_tree,
274 bool);
275 static rtx frv_libcall_value (enum machine_mode,
276 const_rtx);
277 static FRV_INLINE int frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (int, int);
278 static rtx single_set_pattern (rtx);
279 static int frv_function_contains_far_jump (void);
280 static rtx frv_alloc_temp_reg (frv_tmp_reg_t *,
281 enum reg_class,
282 enum machine_mode,
283 int, int);
284 static rtx frv_frame_offset_rtx (int);
285 static rtx frv_frame_mem (enum machine_mode, rtx, int);
286 static rtx frv_dwarf_store (rtx, int);
287 static void frv_frame_insn (rtx, rtx);
288 static void frv_frame_access (frv_frame_accessor_t*,
289 rtx, int);
290 static void frv_frame_access_multi (frv_frame_accessor_t*,
291 frv_stack_t *, int);
292 static void frv_frame_access_standard_regs (enum frv_stack_op,
293 frv_stack_t *);
294 static struct machine_function *frv_init_machine_status (void);
295 static rtx frv_int_to_acc (enum insn_code, int, rtx);
296 static enum machine_mode frv_matching_accg_mode (enum machine_mode);
297 static rtx frv_read_argument (tree, unsigned int);
298 static rtx frv_read_iacc_argument (enum machine_mode, tree, unsigned int);
299 static int frv_check_constant_argument (enum insn_code, int, rtx);
300 static rtx frv_legitimize_target (enum insn_code, rtx);
301 static rtx frv_legitimize_argument (enum insn_code, int, rtx);
302 static rtx frv_legitimize_tls_address (rtx, enum tls_model);
303 static rtx frv_legitimize_address (rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode);
304 static rtx frv_expand_set_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
305 static rtx frv_expand_unop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
306 static rtx frv_expand_binop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
307 static rtx frv_expand_cut_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
308 static rtx frv_expand_binopimm_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
309 static rtx frv_expand_voidbinop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
310 static rtx frv_expand_int_void2arg (enum insn_code, tree);
311 static rtx frv_expand_prefetches (enum insn_code, tree);
312 static rtx frv_expand_voidtriop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
313 static rtx frv_expand_voidaccop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
314 static rtx frv_expand_mclracc_builtin (tree);
315 static rtx frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
316 static rtx frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
317 static rtx frv_expand_noargs_builtin (enum insn_code);
318 static void frv_split_iacc_move (rtx, rtx);
319 static rtx frv_emit_comparison (enum rtx_code, rtx, rtx);
320 static int frv_clear_registers_used (rtx *, void *);
321 static void frv_ifcvt_add_insn (rtx, rtx, int);
322 static rtx frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx);
323 static rtx frv_ifcvt_load_value (rtx, rtx);
324 static int frv_acc_group_1 (rtx *, void *);
325 static unsigned int frv_insn_unit (rtx);
326 static bool frv_issues_to_branch_unit_p (rtx);
327 static int frv_cond_flags (rtx);
328 static bool frv_regstate_conflict_p (regstate_t, regstate_t);
329 static int frv_registers_conflict_p_1 (rtx *, void *);
330 static bool frv_registers_conflict_p (rtx);
331 static void frv_registers_update_1 (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
332 static void frv_registers_update (rtx);
333 static void frv_start_packet (void);
334 static void frv_start_packet_block (void);
335 static void frv_finish_packet (void (*) (void));
336 static bool frv_pack_insn_p (rtx);
337 static void frv_add_insn_to_packet (rtx);
338 static void frv_insert_nop_in_packet (rtx);
339 static bool frv_for_each_packet (void (*) (void));
340 static bool frv_sort_insn_group_1 (enum frv_insn_group,
341 unsigned int, unsigned int,
342 unsigned int, unsigned int,
343 state_t);
344 static int frv_compare_insns (const void *, const void *);
345 static void frv_sort_insn_group (enum frv_insn_group);
346 static void frv_reorder_packet (void);
347 static void frv_fill_unused_units (enum frv_insn_group);
348 static void frv_align_label (void);
349 static void frv_reorg_packet (void);
350 static void frv_register_nop (rtx);
351 static void frv_reorg (void);
352 static void frv_pack_insns (void);
353 static void frv_function_prologue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
354 static void frv_function_epilogue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
355 static bool frv_assemble_integer (rtx, unsigned, int);
356 static void frv_init_builtins (void);
357 static rtx frv_expand_builtin (tree, rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
358 static void frv_init_libfuncs (void);
359 static bool frv_in_small_data_p (const_tree);
360 static void frv_asm_output_mi_thunk
361 (FILE *, tree, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT, tree);
362 static void frv_setup_incoming_varargs (cumulative_args_t,
363 enum machine_mode,
364 tree, int *, int);
365 static rtx frv_expand_builtin_saveregs (void);
366 static void frv_expand_builtin_va_start (tree, rtx);
367 static bool frv_rtx_costs (rtx, int, int, int, int*,
368 bool);
369 static int frv_register_move_cost (enum machine_mode,
370 reg_class_t, reg_class_t);
371 static int frv_memory_move_cost (enum machine_mode,
372 reg_class_t, bool);
373 static void frv_asm_out_constructor (rtx, int);
374 static void frv_asm_out_destructor (rtx, int);
375 static bool frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (rtx);
376 static bool frv_legitimate_constant_p (enum machine_mode, rtx);
377 static bool frv_cannot_force_const_mem (enum machine_mode, rtx);
378 static const char *unspec_got_name (int);
379 static void frv_output_const_unspec (FILE *,
380 const struct frv_unspec *);
381 static bool frv_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree, tree);
382 static rtx frv_struct_value_rtx (tree, int);
383 static bool frv_must_pass_in_stack (enum machine_mode mode, const_tree type);
384 static int frv_arg_partial_bytes (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
385 tree, bool);
386 static rtx frv_function_arg (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
387 const_tree, bool);
388 static rtx frv_function_incoming_arg (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
389 const_tree, bool);
390 static void frv_function_arg_advance (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
391 const_tree, bool);
392 static unsigned int frv_function_arg_boundary (enum machine_mode,
393 const_tree);
394 static void frv_output_dwarf_dtprel (FILE *, int, rtx)
395 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
396 static reg_class_t frv_secondary_reload (bool, rtx, reg_class_t,
397 enum machine_mode,
398 secondary_reload_info *);
399 static bool frv_frame_pointer_required (void);
400 static bool frv_can_eliminate (const int, const int);
401 static void frv_conditional_register_usage (void);
402 static void frv_trampoline_init (rtx, tree, rtx);
403 static bool frv_class_likely_spilled_p (reg_class_t);
405 /* Initialize the GCC target structure. */
406 #undef TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND
407 #define TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND frv_print_operand
408 #undef TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS
409 #define TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS frv_print_operand_address
410 #undef TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P
411 #define TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P frv_print_operand_punct_valid_p
412 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
413 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE frv_function_prologue
414 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
415 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE frv_function_epilogue
416 #undef TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
417 #define TARGET_ASM_INTEGER frv_assemble_integer
418 #undef TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
419 #define TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE frv_option_override
420 #undef TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
421 #define TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS frv_init_builtins
422 #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
423 #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN frv_expand_builtin
424 #undef TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
425 #define TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS frv_init_libfuncs
426 #undef TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
427 #define TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P frv_in_small_data_p
428 #undef TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
429 #define TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST frv_register_move_cost
430 #undef TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
431 #define TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST frv_memory_move_cost
432 #undef TARGET_RTX_COSTS
433 #define TARGET_RTX_COSTS frv_rtx_costs
434 #undef TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
435 #define TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR frv_asm_out_constructor
436 #undef TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
437 #define TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR frv_asm_out_destructor
439 #undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
440 #define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK frv_asm_output_mi_thunk
441 #undef TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
442 #define TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK default_can_output_mi_thunk_no_vcall
444 #undef TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
445 #define TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE frv_issue_rate
447 #undef TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
448 #define TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS frv_legitimize_address
450 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
451 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL frv_function_ok_for_sibcall
452 #undef TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
453 #define TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P frv_legitimate_constant_p
454 #undef TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
455 #define TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM frv_cannot_force_const_mem
457 #undef TARGET_HAVE_TLS
458 #define TARGET_HAVE_TLS HAVE_AS_TLS
460 #undef TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
461 #define TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX frv_struct_value_rtx
462 #undef TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
463 #define TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK frv_must_pass_in_stack
464 #undef TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
465 #define TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE hook_pass_by_reference_must_pass_in_stack
466 #undef TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
467 #define TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES frv_arg_partial_bytes
468 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
469 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG frv_function_arg
470 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
471 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG frv_function_incoming_arg
472 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
473 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE frv_function_arg_advance
474 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
475 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY frv_function_arg_boundary
477 #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
478 #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS frv_expand_builtin_saveregs
479 #undef TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
480 #define TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS frv_setup_incoming_varargs
481 #undef TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
482 #define TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG frv_reorg
484 #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_VA_START
485 #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_VA_START frv_expand_builtin_va_start
487 #if HAVE_AS_TLS
488 #undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
489 #define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL frv_output_dwarf_dtprel
490 #endif
492 #undef TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
493 #define TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P frv_class_likely_spilled_p
495 #undef TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
496 #define TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD frv_secondary_reload
498 #undef TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
499 #define TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P frv_legitimate_address_p
501 #undef TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
502 #define TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED frv_frame_pointer_required
504 #undef TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
505 #define TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE frv_can_eliminate
507 #undef TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
508 #define TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE frv_conditional_register_usage
510 #undef TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
511 #define TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT frv_trampoline_init
513 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
514 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE frv_function_value
515 #undef TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
516 #define TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE frv_libcall_value
518 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
520 #define FRV_SYMBOL_REF_TLS_P(RTX) \
521 (GET_CODE (RTX) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (RTX) != 0)
524 /* Any function call that satisfies the machine-independent
525 requirements is eligible on FR-V. */
527 static bool
528 frv_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
529 tree exp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
531 return true;
534 /* Return true if SYMBOL is a small data symbol and relocation RELOC
535 can be used to access it directly in a load or store. */
537 static FRV_INLINE bool
538 frv_small_data_reloc_p (rtx symbol, int reloc)
540 return (GET_CODE (symbol) == SYMBOL_REF
541 && SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (symbol)
542 && (!TARGET_FDPIC || flag_pic == 1)
543 && (reloc == R_FRV_GOTOFF12 || reloc == R_FRV_GPREL12));
546 /* Return true if X is a valid relocation unspec. If it is, fill in UNSPEC
547 appropriately. */
549 bool
550 frv_const_unspec_p (rtx x, struct frv_unspec *unspec)
552 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST)
554 unspec->offset = 0;
555 x = XEXP (x, 0);
556 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
558 unspec->offset += INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
559 x = XEXP (x, 0);
561 if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_GOT)
563 unspec->symbol = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
564 unspec->reloc = INTVAL (XVECEXP (x, 0, 1));
566 if (unspec->offset == 0)
567 return true;
569 if (frv_small_data_reloc_p (unspec->symbol, unspec->reloc)
570 && unspec->offset > 0
571 && unspec->offset < g_switch_value)
572 return true;
575 return false;
578 /* Decide whether we can force certain constants to memory. If we
579 decide we can't, the caller should be able to cope with it in
580 another way.
582 We never allow constants to be forced into memory for TARGET_FDPIC.
583 This is necessary for several reasons:
585 1. Since frv_legitimate_constant_p rejects constant pool addresses, the
586 target-independent code will try to force them into the constant
587 pool, thus leading to infinite recursion.
589 2. We can never introduce new constant pool references during reload.
590 Any such reference would require use of the pseudo FDPIC register.
592 3. We can't represent a constant added to a function pointer (which is
593 not the same as a pointer to a function+constant).
595 4. In many cases, it's more efficient to calculate the constant in-line. */
597 static bool
598 frv_cannot_force_const_mem (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
599 rtx x ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
601 return TARGET_FDPIC;
604 static int
605 frv_default_flags_for_cpu (void)
607 switch (frv_cpu_type)
609 case FRV_CPU_GENERIC:
610 return MASK_DEFAULT_FRV;
612 case FRV_CPU_FR550:
613 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR550;
615 case FRV_CPU_FR500:
616 case FRV_CPU_TOMCAT:
617 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR500;
619 case FRV_CPU_FR450:
620 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR450;
622 case FRV_CPU_FR405:
623 case FRV_CPU_FR400:
624 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR400;
626 case FRV_CPU_FR300:
627 case FRV_CPU_SIMPLE:
628 return MASK_DEFAULT_SIMPLE;
630 default:
631 gcc_unreachable ();
635 /* Implement TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE. */
637 static void
638 frv_option_override (void)
640 int regno;
641 unsigned int i;
643 target_flags |= (frv_default_flags_for_cpu () & ~target_flags_explicit);
645 /* -mlibrary-pic sets -fPIC and -G0 and also suppresses warnings from the
646 linker about linking pic and non-pic code. */
647 if (TARGET_LIBPIC)
649 if (!flag_pic) /* -fPIC */
650 flag_pic = 2;
652 if (!global_options_set.x_g_switch_value) /* -G0 */
654 g_switch_value = 0;
658 /* A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard
659 register REGNO. In general there is more than one such class;
660 choose a class which is "minimal", meaning that no smaller class
661 also contains the register. */
663 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
665 enum reg_class rclass;
667 if (GPR_P (regno))
669 int gpr_reg = regno - GPR_FIRST;
671 if (gpr_reg == GR8_REG)
672 rclass = GR8_REGS;
674 else if (gpr_reg == GR9_REG)
675 rclass = GR9_REGS;
677 else if (gpr_reg == GR14_REG)
678 rclass = FDPIC_FPTR_REGS;
680 else if (gpr_reg == FDPIC_REGNO)
681 rclass = FDPIC_REGS;
683 else if ((gpr_reg & 3) == 0)
684 rclass = QUAD_REGS;
686 else if ((gpr_reg & 1) == 0)
687 rclass = EVEN_REGS;
689 else
690 rclass = GPR_REGS;
693 else if (FPR_P (regno))
695 int fpr_reg = regno - GPR_FIRST;
696 if ((fpr_reg & 3) == 0)
697 rclass = QUAD_FPR_REGS;
699 else if ((fpr_reg & 1) == 0)
700 rclass = FEVEN_REGS;
702 else
703 rclass = FPR_REGS;
706 else if (regno == LR_REGNO)
707 rclass = LR_REG;
709 else if (regno == LCR_REGNO)
710 rclass = LCR_REG;
712 else if (ICC_P (regno))
713 rclass = ICC_REGS;
715 else if (FCC_P (regno))
716 rclass = FCC_REGS;
718 else if (ICR_P (regno))
719 rclass = ICR_REGS;
721 else if (FCR_P (regno))
722 rclass = FCR_REGS;
724 else if (ACC_P (regno))
726 int r = regno - ACC_FIRST;
727 if ((r & 3) == 0)
728 rclass = QUAD_ACC_REGS;
729 else if ((r & 1) == 0)
730 rclass = EVEN_ACC_REGS;
731 else
732 rclass = ACC_REGS;
735 else if (ACCG_P (regno))
736 rclass = ACCG_REGS;
738 else
739 rclass = NO_REGS;
741 regno_reg_class[regno] = rclass;
744 /* Check for small data option */
745 if (!global_options_set.x_g_switch_value && !TARGET_LIBPIC)
746 g_switch_value = SDATA_DEFAULT_SIZE;
748 /* There is no single unaligned SI op for PIC code. Sometimes we
749 need to use ".4byte" and sometimes we need to use ".picptr".
750 See frv_assemble_integer for details. */
751 if (flag_pic || TARGET_FDPIC)
752 targetm.asm_out.unaligned_op.si = 0;
754 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_LINKED_FP) == 0)
755 target_flags |= MASK_LINKED_FP;
757 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_OPTIMIZE_MEMBAR) == 0)
758 target_flags |= MASK_OPTIMIZE_MEMBAR;
760 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names); i++)
761 frv_unit_codes[i] = get_cpu_unit_code (frv_unit_names[i]);
763 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_type_to_unit); i++)
764 frv_type_to_unit[i] = ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes);
766 init_machine_status = frv_init_machine_status;
770 /* Return true if NAME (a STRING_CST node) begins with PREFIX. */
772 static int
773 frv_string_begins_with (const_tree name, const char *prefix)
775 const int prefix_len = strlen (prefix);
777 /* Remember: NAME's length includes the null terminator. */
778 return (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (name) > prefix_len
779 && strncmp (TREE_STRING_POINTER (name), prefix, prefix_len) == 0);
782 /* Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify two variables
783 `fixed_regs' and `call_used_regs' (both of type `char []') after they have
784 been initialized from the two preceding macros.
786 This is necessary in case the fixed or call-clobbered registers depend on
787 target flags.
789 You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
791 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target flags,
792 you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify `fixed_regs' and
793 `call_used_regs' to 1 for each of the registers in the classes which should
794 not be used by GCC. Also define the macro `REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER' to return
795 `NO_REGS' if it is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
797 (However, if this class is not included in `GENERAL_REGS' and all of the
798 insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are controlled by target
799 switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using these registers when the
800 target switches are opposed to them.) */
802 static void
803 frv_conditional_register_usage (void)
805 int i;
807 for (i = GPR_FIRST + NUM_GPRS; i <= GPR_LAST; i++)
808 fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1;
810 for (i = FPR_FIRST + NUM_FPRS; i <= FPR_LAST; i++)
811 fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1;
813 /* Reserve the registers used for conditional execution. At present, we need
814 1 ICC and 1 ICR register. */
815 fixed_regs[ICC_TEMP] = call_used_regs[ICC_TEMP] = 1;
816 fixed_regs[ICR_TEMP] = call_used_regs[ICR_TEMP] = 1;
818 if (TARGET_FIXED_CC)
820 fixed_regs[ICC_FIRST] = call_used_regs[ICC_FIRST] = 1;
821 fixed_regs[FCC_FIRST] = call_used_regs[FCC_FIRST] = 1;
822 fixed_regs[ICR_FIRST] = call_used_regs[ICR_FIRST] = 1;
823 fixed_regs[FCR_FIRST] = call_used_regs[FCR_FIRST] = 1;
826 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
827 fixed_regs[GPR_FIRST + 16] = fixed_regs[GPR_FIRST + 17] =
828 call_used_regs[GPR_FIRST + 16] = call_used_regs[GPR_FIRST + 17] = 0;
830 #if 0
831 /* If -fpic, SDA_BASE_REG is the PIC register. */
832 if (g_switch_value == 0 && !flag_pic)
833 fixed_regs[SDA_BASE_REG] = call_used_regs[SDA_BASE_REG] = 0;
835 if (!flag_pic)
836 fixed_regs[PIC_REGNO] = call_used_regs[PIC_REGNO] = 0;
837 #endif
842 * Compute the stack frame layout
844 * Register setup:
845 * +---------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+
846 * |Register |type |caller-save/callee-save|
847 * +---------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+
848 * |GR0 |Zero register | - |
849 * |GR1 |Stack pointer(SP) | - |
850 * |GR2 |Frame pointer(FP) | - |
851 * |GR3 |Hidden parameter | caller save |
852 * |GR4-GR7 | - | caller save |
853 * |GR8-GR13 |Argument register | caller save |
854 * |GR14-GR15 | - | caller save |
855 * |GR16-GR31 | - | callee save |
856 * |GR32-GR47 | - | caller save |
857 * |GR48-GR63 | - | callee save |
858 * |FR0-FR15 | - | caller save |
859 * |FR16-FR31 | - | callee save |
860 * |FR32-FR47 | - | caller save |
861 * |FR48-FR63 | - | callee save |
862 * +---------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+
864 * Stack frame setup:
865 * Low
866 * SP-> |-----------------------------------|
867 * | Argument area |
868 * |-----------------------------------|
869 * | Register save area |
870 * |-----------------------------------|
871 * | Local variable save area |
872 * FP-> |-----------------------------------|
873 * | Old FP |
874 * |-----------------------------------|
875 * | Hidden parameter save area |
876 * |-----------------------------------|
877 * | Return address(LR) storage area |
878 * |-----------------------------------|
879 * | Padding for alignment |
880 * |-----------------------------------|
881 * | Register argument area |
882 * OLD SP-> |-----------------------------------|
883 * | Parameter area |
884 * |-----------------------------------|
885 * High
887 * Argument area/Parameter area:
889 * When a function is called, this area is used for argument transfer. When
890 * the argument is set up by the caller function, this area is referred to as
891 * the argument area. When the argument is referenced by the callee function,
892 * this area is referred to as the parameter area. The area is allocated when
893 * all arguments cannot be placed on the argument register at the time of
894 * argument transfer.
896 * Register save area:
898 * This is a register save area that must be guaranteed for the caller
899 * function. This area is not secured when the register save operation is not
900 * needed.
902 * Local variable save area:
904 * This is the area for local variables and temporary variables.
906 * Old FP:
908 * This area stores the FP value of the caller function.
910 * Hidden parameter save area:
912 * This area stores the start address of the return value storage
913 * area for a struct/union return function.
914 * When a struct/union is used as the return value, the caller
915 * function stores the return value storage area start address in
916 * register GR3 and passes it to the caller function.
917 * The callee function interprets the address stored in the GR3
918 * as the return value storage area start address.
919 * When register GR3 needs to be saved into memory, the callee
920 * function saves it in the hidden parameter save area. This
921 * area is not secured when the save operation is not needed.
923 * Return address(LR) storage area:
925 * This area saves the LR. The LR stores the address of a return to the caller
926 * function for the purpose of function calling.
928 * Argument register area:
930 * This area saves the argument register. This area is not secured when the
931 * save operation is not needed.
933 * Argument:
935 * Arguments, the count of which equals the count of argument registers (6
936 * words), are positioned in registers GR8 to GR13 and delivered to the callee
937 * function. When a struct/union return function is called, the return value
938 * area address is stored in register GR3. Arguments not placed in the
939 * argument registers will be stored in the stack argument area for transfer
940 * purposes. When an 8-byte type argument is to be delivered using registers,
941 * it is divided into two and placed in two registers for transfer. When
942 * argument registers must be saved to memory, the callee function secures an
943 * argument register save area in the stack. In this case, a continuous
944 * argument register save area must be established in the parameter area. The
945 * argument register save area must be allocated as needed to cover the size of
946 * the argument register to be saved. If the function has a variable count of
947 * arguments, it saves all argument registers in the argument register save
948 * area.
950 * Argument Extension Format:
952 * When an argument is to be stored in the stack, its type is converted to an
953 * extended type in accordance with the individual argument type. The argument
954 * is freed by the caller function after the return from the callee function is
955 * made.
957 * +-----------------------+---------------+------------------------+
958 * | Argument Type |Extended Type |Stack Storage Size(byte)|
959 * +-----------------------+---------------+------------------------+
960 * |char |int | 4 |
961 * |signed char |int | 4 |
962 * |unsigned char |int | 4 |
963 * |[signed] short int |int | 4 |
964 * |unsigned short int |int | 4 |
965 * |[signed] int |No extension | 4 |
966 * |unsigned int |No extension | 4 |
967 * |[signed] long int |No extension | 4 |
968 * |unsigned long int |No extension | 4 |
969 * |[signed] long long int |No extension | 8 |
970 * |unsigned long long int |No extension | 8 |
971 * |float |double | 8 |
972 * |double |No extension | 8 |
973 * |long double |No extension | 8 |
974 * |pointer |No extension | 4 |
975 * |struct/union |- | 4 (*1) |
976 * +-----------------------+---------------+------------------------+
978 * When a struct/union is to be delivered as an argument, the caller copies it
979 * to the local variable area and delivers the address of that area.
981 * Return Value:
983 * +-------------------------------+----------------------+
984 * |Return Value Type |Return Value Interface|
985 * +-------------------------------+----------------------+
986 * |void |None |
987 * |[signed|unsigned] char |GR8 |
988 * |[signed|unsigned] short int |GR8 |
989 * |[signed|unsigned] int |GR8 |
990 * |[signed|unsigned] long int |GR8 |
991 * |pointer |GR8 |
992 * |[signed|unsigned] long long int|GR8 & GR9 |
993 * |float |GR8 |
994 * |double |GR8 & GR9 |
995 * |long double |GR8 & GR9 |
996 * |struct/union |(*1) |
997 * +-------------------------------+----------------------+
999 * When a struct/union is used as the return value, the caller function stores
1000 * the start address of the return value storage area into GR3 and then passes
1001 * it to the callee function. The callee function interprets GR3 as the start
1002 * address of the return value storage area. When this address needs to be
1003 * saved in memory, the callee function secures the hidden parameter save area
1004 * and saves the address in that area.
1007 frv_stack_t *
1008 frv_stack_info (void)
1010 static frv_stack_t info, zero_info;
1011 frv_stack_t *info_ptr = &info;
1012 tree fndecl = current_function_decl;
1013 int varargs_p = 0;
1014 tree cur_arg;
1015 tree next_arg;
1016 int range;
1017 int alignment;
1018 int offset;
1020 /* If we've already calculated the values and reload is complete,
1021 just return now. */
1022 if (frv_stack_cache)
1023 return frv_stack_cache;
1025 /* Zero all fields. */
1026 info = zero_info;
1028 /* Set up the register range information. */
1029 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].name = "gpr";
1030 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].first = LAST_ARG_REGNUM + 1;
1031 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].last = GPR_LAST;
1032 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].dword_p = TRUE;
1034 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].name = "fpr";
1035 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].first = FPR_FIRST;
1036 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].last = FPR_LAST;
1037 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].dword_p = TRUE;
1039 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].name = "lr";
1040 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].first = LR_REGNO;
1041 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].last = LR_REGNO;
1042 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].special_p = 1;
1044 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].name = "cc";
1045 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].first = CC_FIRST;
1046 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].last = CC_LAST;
1047 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].field_p = TRUE;
1049 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LCR].name = "lcr";
1050 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LCR].first = LCR_REGNO;
1051 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LCR].last = LCR_REGNO;
1053 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].name = "stdarg";
1054 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].first = FIRST_ARG_REGNUM;
1055 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].last = LAST_ARG_REGNUM;
1056 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].dword_p = 1;
1057 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].special_p = 1;
1059 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].name = "struct";
1060 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].first = FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM;
1061 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].last = FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM;
1062 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].special_p = 1;
1064 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].name = "fp";
1065 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].first = FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1066 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].last = FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1067 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].special_p = 1;
1069 /* Determine if this is a stdarg function. If so, allocate space to store
1070 the 6 arguments. */
1071 if (cfun->stdarg)
1072 varargs_p = 1;
1074 else
1076 /* Find the last argument, and see if it is __builtin_va_alist. */
1077 for (cur_arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl); cur_arg != (tree)0; cur_arg = next_arg)
1079 next_arg = DECL_CHAIN (cur_arg);
1080 if (next_arg == (tree)0)
1082 if (DECL_NAME (cur_arg)
1083 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (cur_arg)), "__builtin_va_alist"))
1084 varargs_p = 1;
1086 break;
1091 /* Iterate over all of the register ranges. */
1092 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1094 frv_stack_regs_t *reg_ptr = &(info_ptr->regs[range]);
1095 int first = reg_ptr->first;
1096 int last = reg_ptr->last;
1097 int size_1word = 0;
1098 int size_2words = 0;
1099 int regno;
1101 /* Calculate which registers need to be saved & save area size. */
1102 switch (range)
1104 default:
1105 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1107 if ((df_regs_ever_live_p (regno) && !call_used_regs[regno])
1108 || (crtl->calls_eh_return
1109 && (regno >= FIRST_EH_REGNUM && regno <= LAST_EH_REGNUM))
1110 || (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic
1111 && crtl->uses_pic_offset_table && regno == PIC_REGNO))
1113 info_ptr->save_p[regno] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1114 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1117 break;
1119 /* Calculate whether we need to create a frame after everything else
1120 has been processed. */
1121 case STACK_REGS_FP:
1122 break;
1124 case STACK_REGS_LR:
1125 if (df_regs_ever_live_p (LR_REGNO)
1126 || profile_flag
1127 /* This is set for __builtin_return_address, etc. */
1128 || cfun->machine->frame_needed
1129 || (TARGET_LINKED_FP && frame_pointer_needed)
1130 || (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic
1131 && crtl->uses_pic_offset_table))
1133 info_ptr->save_p[LR_REGNO] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1134 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1136 break;
1138 case STACK_REGS_STDARG:
1139 if (varargs_p)
1141 /* If this is a stdarg function with a non varardic
1142 argument split between registers and the stack,
1143 adjust the saved registers downward. */
1144 last -= (ADDR_ALIGN (crtl->args.pretend_args_size, UNITS_PER_WORD)
1145 / UNITS_PER_WORD);
1147 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1149 info_ptr->save_p[regno] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1150 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1153 info_ptr->stdarg_size = size_1word;
1155 break;
1157 case STACK_REGS_STRUCT:
1158 if (cfun->returns_struct)
1160 info_ptr->save_p[FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1161 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1163 break;
1167 if (size_1word)
1169 /* If this is a field, it only takes one word. */
1170 if (reg_ptr->field_p)
1171 size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1173 /* Determine which register pairs can be saved together. */
1174 else if (reg_ptr->dword_p && TARGET_DWORD)
1176 for (regno = first; regno < last; regno += 2)
1178 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] && info_ptr->save_p[regno+1])
1180 size_2words += 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1181 size_1word -= 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1182 info_ptr->save_p[regno] = REG_SAVE_2WORDS;
1183 info_ptr->save_p[regno+1] = REG_SAVE_NO_SAVE;
1188 reg_ptr->size_1word = size_1word;
1189 reg_ptr->size_2words = size_2words;
1191 if (! reg_ptr->special_p)
1193 info_ptr->regs_size_1word += size_1word;
1194 info_ptr->regs_size_2words += size_2words;
1199 /* Set up the sizes of each each field in the frame body, making the sizes
1200 of each be divisible by the size of a dword if dword operations might
1201 be used, or the size of a word otherwise. */
1202 alignment = (TARGET_DWORD? 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD : UNITS_PER_WORD);
1204 info_ptr->parameter_size = ADDR_ALIGN (crtl->outgoing_args_size, alignment);
1205 info_ptr->regs_size = ADDR_ALIGN (info_ptr->regs_size_2words
1206 + info_ptr->regs_size_1word,
1207 alignment);
1208 info_ptr->vars_size = ADDR_ALIGN (get_frame_size (), alignment);
1210 info_ptr->pretend_size = crtl->args.pretend_args_size;
1212 /* Work out the size of the frame, excluding the header. Both the frame
1213 body and register parameter area will be dword-aligned. */
1214 info_ptr->total_size
1215 = (ADDR_ALIGN (info_ptr->parameter_size
1216 + info_ptr->regs_size
1217 + info_ptr->vars_size,
1218 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD)
1219 + ADDR_ALIGN (info_ptr->pretend_size
1220 + info_ptr->stdarg_size,
1221 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD));
1223 /* See if we need to create a frame at all, if so add header area. */
1224 if (info_ptr->total_size > 0
1225 || frame_pointer_needed
1226 || info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].size_1word > 0
1227 || info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].size_1word > 0)
1229 offset = info_ptr->parameter_size;
1230 info_ptr->header_size = 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1231 info_ptr->total_size += 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1233 /* Calculate the offsets to save normal register pairs. */
1234 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1236 frv_stack_regs_t *reg_ptr = &(info_ptr->regs[range]);
1237 if (! reg_ptr->special_p)
1239 int first = reg_ptr->first;
1240 int last = reg_ptr->last;
1241 int regno;
1243 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1244 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS
1245 && regno != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1246 && (regno < FIRST_ARG_REGNUM
1247 || regno > LAST_ARG_REGNUM))
1249 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1250 offset += 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1255 /* Calculate the offsets to save normal single registers. */
1256 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1258 frv_stack_regs_t *reg_ptr = &(info_ptr->regs[range]);
1259 if (! reg_ptr->special_p)
1261 int first = reg_ptr->first;
1262 int last = reg_ptr->last;
1263 int regno;
1265 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1266 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_1WORD
1267 && regno != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1268 && (regno < FIRST_ARG_REGNUM
1269 || regno > LAST_ARG_REGNUM))
1271 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1272 offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1277 /* Calculate the offset to save the local variables at. */
1278 offset = ADDR_ALIGN (offset, alignment);
1279 if (info_ptr->vars_size)
1281 info_ptr->vars_offset = offset;
1282 offset += info_ptr->vars_size;
1285 /* Align header to a dword-boundary. */
1286 offset = ADDR_ALIGN (offset, 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD);
1288 /* Calculate the offsets in the fixed frame. */
1289 info_ptr->save_p[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1290 info_ptr->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM] = offset;
1291 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1293 info_ptr->save_p[LR_REGNO] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1294 info_ptr->reg_offset[LR_REGNO] = offset + 2*UNITS_PER_WORD;
1295 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1297 if (cfun->returns_struct)
1299 info_ptr->save_p[FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1300 info_ptr->reg_offset[FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM] = offset + UNITS_PER_WORD;
1301 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1304 /* Calculate the offsets to store the arguments passed in registers
1305 for stdarg functions. The register pairs are first and the single
1306 register if any is last. The register save area starts on a
1307 dword-boundary. */
1308 if (info_ptr->stdarg_size)
1310 int first = info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].first;
1311 int last = info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].last;
1312 int regno;
1314 /* Skip the header. */
1315 offset += 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1316 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1318 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS)
1320 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1321 offset += 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1323 else if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_1WORD)
1325 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1326 offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1332 if (reload_completed)
1333 frv_stack_cache = info_ptr;
1335 return info_ptr;
1339 /* Print the information about the frv stack offsets, etc. when debugging. */
1341 void
1342 frv_debug_stack (frv_stack_t *info)
1344 int range;
1346 if (!info)
1347 info = frv_stack_info ();
1349 fprintf (stderr, "\nStack information for function %s:\n",
1350 ((current_function_decl && DECL_NAME (current_function_decl))
1351 ? IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (current_function_decl))
1352 : "<unknown>"));
1354 fprintf (stderr, "\ttotal_size\t= %6d\n", info->total_size);
1355 fprintf (stderr, "\tvars_size\t= %6d\n", info->vars_size);
1356 fprintf (stderr, "\tparam_size\t= %6d\n", info->parameter_size);
1357 fprintf (stderr, "\tregs_size\t= %6d, 1w = %3d, 2w = %3d\n",
1358 info->regs_size, info->regs_size_1word, info->regs_size_2words);
1360 fprintf (stderr, "\theader_size\t= %6d\n", info->header_size);
1361 fprintf (stderr, "\tpretend_size\t= %6d\n", info->pretend_size);
1362 fprintf (stderr, "\tvars_offset\t= %6d\n", info->vars_offset);
1363 fprintf (stderr, "\tregs_offset\t= %6d\n", info->regs_offset);
1365 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1367 frv_stack_regs_t *regs = &(info->regs[range]);
1368 if ((regs->size_1word + regs->size_2words) > 0)
1370 int first = regs->first;
1371 int last = regs->last;
1372 int regno;
1374 fprintf (stderr, "\t%s\tsize\t= %6d, 1w = %3d, 2w = %3d, save =",
1375 regs->name, regs->size_1word + regs->size_2words,
1376 regs->size_1word, regs->size_2words);
1378 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1380 if (info->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_1WORD)
1381 fprintf (stderr, " %s (%d)", reg_names[regno],
1382 info->reg_offset[regno]);
1384 else if (info->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS)
1385 fprintf (stderr, " %s-%s (%d)", reg_names[regno],
1386 reg_names[regno+1], info->reg_offset[regno]);
1389 fputc ('\n', stderr);
1393 fflush (stderr);
1399 /* Used during final to control the packing of insns. The value is
1400 1 if the current instruction should be packed with the next one,
1401 0 if it shouldn't or -1 if packing is disabled altogether. */
1403 static int frv_insn_packing_flag;
1405 /* True if the current function contains a far jump. */
1407 static int
1408 frv_function_contains_far_jump (void)
1410 rtx insn = get_insns ();
1411 while (insn != NULL
1412 && !(GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
1413 /* Ignore tablejump patterns. */
1414 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != ADDR_VEC
1415 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != ADDR_DIFF_VEC
1416 && get_attr_far_jump (insn) == FAR_JUMP_YES))
1417 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1418 return (insn != NULL);
1421 /* For the FRV, this function makes sure that a function with far jumps
1422 will return correctly. It also does the VLIW packing. */
1424 static void
1425 frv_function_prologue (FILE *file, HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1427 rtx insn, next, last_call;
1429 /* If no frame was created, check whether the function uses a call
1430 instruction to implement a far jump. If so, save the link in gr3 and
1431 replace all returns to LR with returns to GR3. GR3 is used because it
1432 is call-clobbered, because is not available to the register allocator,
1433 and because all functions that take a hidden argument pointer will have
1434 a stack frame. */
1435 if (frv_stack_info ()->total_size == 0 && frv_function_contains_far_jump ())
1437 rtx insn;
1439 /* Just to check that the above comment is true. */
1440 gcc_assert (!df_regs_ever_live_p (GPR_FIRST + 3));
1442 /* Generate the instruction that saves the link register. */
1443 fprintf (file, "\tmovsg lr,gr3\n");
1445 /* Replace the LR with GR3 in *return_internal patterns. The insn
1446 will now return using jmpl @(gr3,0) rather than bralr. We cannot
1447 simply emit a different assembly directive because bralr and jmpl
1448 execute in different units. */
1449 for (insn = get_insns(); insn != NULL; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1450 if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN)
1452 rtx pattern = PATTERN (insn);
1453 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == PARALLEL
1454 && XVECLEN (pattern, 0) >= 2
1455 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 0)) == RETURN
1456 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 1)) == USE)
1458 rtx address = XEXP (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 1), 0);
1459 if (GET_CODE (address) == REG && REGNO (address) == LR_REGNO)
1460 SET_REGNO (address, GPR_FIRST + 3);
1465 frv_pack_insns ();
1467 /* Allow the garbage collector to free the nops created by frv_reorg. */
1468 memset (frv_nops, 0, sizeof (frv_nops));
1470 /* Locate CALL_ARG_LOCATION notes that have been misplaced
1471 and move them back to where they should be located. */
1472 last_call = NULL_RTX;
1473 for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = next)
1475 next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1476 if (CALL_P (insn)
1477 || (INSN_P (insn) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE
1478 && CALL_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0))))
1479 last_call = insn;
1481 if (!NOTE_P (insn) || NOTE_KIND (insn) != NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION)
1482 continue;
1484 if (NEXT_INSN (last_call) == insn)
1485 continue;
1487 NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn)) = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1488 PREV_INSN (NEXT_INSN (insn)) = PREV_INSN (insn);
1489 PREV_INSN (insn) = last_call;
1490 NEXT_INSN (insn) = NEXT_INSN (last_call);
1491 PREV_INSN (NEXT_INSN (insn)) = insn;
1492 NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn)) = insn;
1493 last_call = insn;
1498 /* Return the next available temporary register in a given class. */
1500 static rtx
1501 frv_alloc_temp_reg (
1502 frv_tmp_reg_t *info, /* which registers are available */
1503 enum reg_class rclass, /* register class desired */
1504 enum machine_mode mode, /* mode to allocate register with */
1505 int mark_as_used, /* register not available after allocation */
1506 int no_abort) /* return NULL instead of aborting */
1508 int regno = info->next_reg[ (int)rclass ];
1509 int orig_regno = regno;
1510 HARD_REG_SET *reg_in_class = &reg_class_contents[ (int)rclass ];
1511 int i, nr;
1513 for (;;)
1515 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*reg_in_class, regno)
1516 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (info->regs, regno))
1517 break;
1519 if (++regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1520 regno = 0;
1521 if (regno == orig_regno)
1523 gcc_assert (no_abort);
1524 return NULL_RTX;
1528 nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
1529 info->next_reg[ (int)rclass ] = regno + nr;
1531 if (mark_as_used)
1532 for (i = 0; i < nr; i++)
1533 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (info->regs, regno+i);
1535 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, regno);
1539 /* Return an rtx with the value OFFSET, which will either be a register or a
1540 signed 12-bit integer. It can be used as the second operand in an "add"
1541 instruction, or as the index in a load or store.
1543 The function returns a constant rtx if OFFSET is small enough, otherwise
1544 it loads the constant into register OFFSET_REGNO and returns that. */
1545 static rtx
1546 frv_frame_offset_rtx (int offset)
1548 rtx offset_rtx = GEN_INT (offset);
1549 if (IN_RANGE (offset, -2048, 2047))
1550 return offset_rtx;
1551 else
1553 rtx reg_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, OFFSET_REGNO);
1554 if (IN_RANGE (offset, -32768, 32767))
1555 emit_insn (gen_movsi (reg_rtx, offset_rtx));
1556 else
1558 emit_insn (gen_movsi_high (reg_rtx, offset_rtx));
1559 emit_insn (gen_movsi_lo_sum (reg_rtx, offset_rtx));
1561 return reg_rtx;
1565 /* Generate (mem:MODE (plus:Pmode BASE (frv_frame_offset OFFSET)))). The
1566 prologue and epilogue uses such expressions to access the stack. */
1567 static rtx
1568 frv_frame_mem (enum machine_mode mode, rtx base, int offset)
1570 return gen_rtx_MEM (mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
1571 base,
1572 frv_frame_offset_rtx (offset)));
1575 /* Generate a frame-related expression:
1577 (set REG (mem (plus (sp) (const_int OFFSET)))).
1579 Such expressions are used in FRAME_RELATED_EXPR notes for more complex
1580 instructions. Marking the expressions as frame-related is superfluous if
1581 the note contains just a single set. But if the note contains a PARALLEL
1582 or SEQUENCE that has several sets, each set must be individually marked
1583 as frame-related. */
1584 static rtx
1585 frv_dwarf_store (rtx reg, int offset)
1587 rtx set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
1588 gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (reg),
1589 plus_constant (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
1590 offset)),
1591 reg);
1592 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (set) = 1;
1593 return set;
1596 /* Emit a frame-related instruction whose pattern is PATTERN. The
1597 instruction is the last in a sequence that cumulatively performs the
1598 operation described by DWARF_PATTERN. The instruction is marked as
1599 frame-related and has a REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR note containing
1600 DWARF_PATTERN. */
1601 static void
1602 frv_frame_insn (rtx pattern, rtx dwarf_pattern)
1604 rtx insn = emit_insn (pattern);
1605 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
1606 REG_NOTES (insn) = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
1607 dwarf_pattern,
1608 REG_NOTES (insn));
1611 /* Emit instructions that transfer REG to or from the memory location (sp +
1612 STACK_OFFSET). The register is stored in memory if ACCESSOR->OP is
1613 FRV_STORE and loaded if it is FRV_LOAD. Only the prologue uses this
1614 function to store registers and only the epilogue uses it to load them.
1616 The caller sets up ACCESSOR so that BASE is equal to (sp + BASE_OFFSET).
1617 The generated instruction will use BASE as its base register. BASE may
1618 simply be the stack pointer, but if several accesses are being made to a
1619 region far away from the stack pointer, it may be more efficient to set
1620 up a temporary instead.
1622 Store instructions will be frame-related and will be annotated with the
1623 overall effect of the store. Load instructions will be followed by a
1624 (use) to prevent later optimizations from zapping them.
1626 The function takes care of the moves to and from SPRs, using TEMP_REGNO
1627 as a temporary in such cases. */
1628 static void
1629 frv_frame_access (frv_frame_accessor_t *accessor, rtx reg, int stack_offset)
1631 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (reg);
1632 rtx mem = frv_frame_mem (mode,
1633 accessor->base,
1634 stack_offset - accessor->base_offset);
1636 if (accessor->op == FRV_LOAD)
1638 if (SPR_P (REGNO (reg)))
1640 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (mode, TEMP_REGNO);
1641 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, temp, mem));
1642 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, temp));
1644 else
1646 /* We cannot use reg+reg addressing for DImode access. */
1647 if (mode == DImode
1648 && GET_CODE (XEXP (mem, 0)) == PLUS
1649 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 0)) == REG
1650 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 1)) == REG)
1652 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, TEMP_REGNO);
1654 emit_move_insn (temp,
1655 gen_rtx_PLUS (SImode, XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 0),
1656 XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 1)));
1657 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, temp);
1659 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, mem));
1661 emit_use (reg);
1663 else
1665 if (SPR_P (REGNO (reg)))
1667 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (mode, TEMP_REGNO);
1668 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, temp, reg));
1669 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (Pmode, mem, temp),
1670 frv_dwarf_store (reg, stack_offset));
1672 else if (mode == DImode)
1674 /* For DImode saves, the dwarf2 version needs to be a SEQUENCE
1675 with a separate save for each register. */
1676 rtx reg1 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (reg));
1677 rtx reg2 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (reg) + 1);
1678 rtx set1 = frv_dwarf_store (reg1, stack_offset);
1679 rtx set2 = frv_dwarf_store (reg2, stack_offset + 4);
1681 /* Also we cannot use reg+reg addressing. */
1682 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (mem, 0)) == PLUS
1683 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 0)) == REG
1684 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 1)) == REG)
1686 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, TEMP_REGNO);
1687 emit_move_insn (temp,
1688 gen_rtx_PLUS (SImode, XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 0),
1689 XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 1)));
1690 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, temp);
1693 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (Pmode, mem, reg),
1694 gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode,
1695 gen_rtvec (2, set1, set2)));
1697 else
1698 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (Pmode, mem, reg),
1699 frv_dwarf_store (reg, stack_offset));
1703 /* A function that uses frv_frame_access to transfer a group of registers to
1704 or from the stack. ACCESSOR is passed directly to frv_frame_access, INFO
1705 is the stack information generated by frv_stack_info, and REG_SET is the
1706 number of the register set to transfer. */
1707 static void
1708 frv_frame_access_multi (frv_frame_accessor_t *accessor,
1709 frv_stack_t *info,
1710 int reg_set)
1712 frv_stack_regs_t *regs_info;
1713 int regno;
1715 regs_info = &info->regs[reg_set];
1716 for (regno = regs_info->first; regno <= regs_info->last; regno++)
1717 if (info->save_p[regno])
1718 frv_frame_access (accessor,
1719 info->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS
1720 ? gen_rtx_REG (DImode, regno)
1721 : gen_rtx_REG (SImode, regno),
1722 info->reg_offset[regno]);
1725 /* Save or restore callee-saved registers that are kept outside the frame
1726 header. The function saves the registers if OP is FRV_STORE and restores
1727 them if OP is FRV_LOAD. INFO is the stack information generated by
1728 frv_stack_info. */
1729 static void
1730 frv_frame_access_standard_regs (enum frv_stack_op op, frv_stack_t *info)
1732 frv_frame_accessor_t accessor;
1734 accessor.op = op;
1735 accessor.base = stack_pointer_rtx;
1736 accessor.base_offset = 0;
1737 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_GPR);
1738 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_FPR);
1739 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_LCR);
1743 /* Called after register allocation to add any instructions needed for the
1744 prologue. Using a prologue insn is favored compared to putting all of the
1745 instructions in the TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE target hook, since
1746 it allows the scheduler to intermix instructions with the saves of
1747 the caller saved registers. In some cases, it might be necessary
1748 to emit a barrier instruction as the last insn to prevent such
1749 scheduling.
1751 Also any insns generated here should have RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P(insn) = 1
1752 so that the debug info generation code can handle them properly. */
1753 void
1754 frv_expand_prologue (void)
1756 frv_stack_t *info = frv_stack_info ();
1757 rtx sp = stack_pointer_rtx;
1758 rtx fp = frame_pointer_rtx;
1759 frv_frame_accessor_t accessor;
1761 if (TARGET_DEBUG_STACK)
1762 frv_debug_stack (info);
1764 if (info->total_size == 0)
1765 return;
1767 /* We're interested in three areas of the frame here:
1769 A: the register save area
1770 B: the old FP
1771 C: the header after B
1773 If the frame pointer isn't used, we'll have to set up A, B and C
1774 using the stack pointer. If the frame pointer is used, we'll access
1775 them as follows:
1777 A: set up using sp
1778 B: set up using sp or a temporary (see below)
1779 C: set up using fp
1781 We set up B using the stack pointer if the frame is small enough.
1782 Otherwise, it's more efficient to copy the old stack pointer into a
1783 temporary and use that.
1785 Note that it's important to make sure the prologue and epilogue use the
1786 same registers to access A and C, since doing otherwise will confuse
1787 the aliasing code. */
1789 /* Set up ACCESSOR for accessing region B above. If the frame pointer
1790 isn't used, the same method will serve for C. */
1791 accessor.op = FRV_STORE;
1792 if (frame_pointer_needed && info->total_size > 2048)
1794 accessor.base = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, OLD_SP_REGNO);
1795 accessor.base_offset = info->total_size;
1796 emit_insn (gen_movsi (accessor.base, sp));
1798 else
1800 accessor.base = stack_pointer_rtx;
1801 accessor.base_offset = 0;
1804 /* Allocate the stack space. */
1806 rtx asm_offset = frv_frame_offset_rtx (-info->total_size);
1807 rtx dwarf_offset = GEN_INT (-info->total_size);
1809 frv_frame_insn (gen_stack_adjust (sp, sp, asm_offset),
1810 gen_rtx_SET (Pmode,
1812 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, sp, dwarf_offset)));
1815 /* If the frame pointer is needed, store the old one at (sp + FP_OFFSET)
1816 and point the new one to that location. */
1817 if (frame_pointer_needed)
1819 int fp_offset = info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM];
1821 /* ASM_SRC and DWARF_SRC both point to the frame header. ASM_SRC is
1822 based on ACCESSOR.BASE but DWARF_SRC is always based on the stack
1823 pointer. */
1824 rtx asm_src = plus_constant (Pmode, accessor.base,
1825 fp_offset - accessor.base_offset);
1826 rtx dwarf_src = plus_constant (Pmode, sp, fp_offset);
1828 /* Store the old frame pointer at (sp + FP_OFFSET). */
1829 frv_frame_access (&accessor, fp, fp_offset);
1831 /* Set up the new frame pointer. */
1832 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, fp, asm_src),
1833 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, fp, dwarf_src));
1835 /* Access region C from the frame pointer. */
1836 accessor.base = fp;
1837 accessor.base_offset = fp_offset;
1840 /* Set up region C. */
1841 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_STRUCT);
1842 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_LR);
1843 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_STDARG);
1845 /* Set up region A. */
1846 frv_frame_access_standard_regs (FRV_STORE, info);
1848 /* If this is a varargs/stdarg function, issue a blockage to prevent the
1849 scheduler from moving loads before the stores saving the registers. */
1850 if (info->stdarg_size > 0)
1851 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
1853 /* Set up pic register/small data register for this function. */
1854 if (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic && crtl->uses_pic_offset_table)
1855 emit_insn (gen_pic_prologue (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, PIC_REGNO),
1856 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO),
1857 gen_rtx_REG (SImode, OFFSET_REGNO)));
1861 /* Under frv, all of the work is done via frv_expand_epilogue, but
1862 this function provides a convenient place to do cleanup. */
1864 static void
1865 frv_function_epilogue (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1866 HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1868 frv_stack_cache = (frv_stack_t *)0;
1870 /* Zap last used registers for conditional execution. */
1871 memset (&frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg, 0, sizeof (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg));
1873 /* Release the bitmap of created insns. */
1874 BITMAP_FREE (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap);
1878 /* Called after register allocation to add any instructions needed for the
1879 epilogue. Using an epilogue insn is favored compared to putting all of the
1880 instructions in the TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE target hook, since
1881 it allows the scheduler to intermix instructions with the saves of
1882 the caller saved registers. In some cases, it might be necessary
1883 to emit a barrier instruction as the last insn to prevent such
1884 scheduling. */
1886 void
1887 frv_expand_epilogue (bool emit_return)
1889 frv_stack_t *info = frv_stack_info ();
1890 rtx fp = frame_pointer_rtx;
1891 rtx sp = stack_pointer_rtx;
1892 rtx return_addr;
1893 int fp_offset;
1895 fp_offset = info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM];
1897 /* Restore the stack pointer to its original value if alloca or the like
1898 is used. */
1899 if (! crtl->sp_is_unchanging)
1900 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (sp, fp, frv_frame_offset_rtx (-fp_offset)));
1902 /* Restore the callee-saved registers that were used in this function. */
1903 frv_frame_access_standard_regs (FRV_LOAD, info);
1905 /* Set RETURN_ADDR to the address we should return to. Set it to NULL if
1906 no return instruction should be emitted. */
1907 if (info->save_p[LR_REGNO])
1909 int lr_offset;
1910 rtx mem;
1912 /* Use the same method to access the link register's slot as we did in
1913 the prologue. In other words, use the frame pointer if available,
1914 otherwise use the stack pointer.
1916 LR_OFFSET is the offset of the link register's slot from the start
1917 of the frame and MEM is a memory rtx for it. */
1918 lr_offset = info->reg_offset[LR_REGNO];
1919 if (frame_pointer_needed)
1920 mem = frv_frame_mem (Pmode, fp, lr_offset - fp_offset);
1921 else
1922 mem = frv_frame_mem (Pmode, sp, lr_offset);
1924 /* Load the old link register into a GPR. */
1925 return_addr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, TEMP_REGNO);
1926 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, return_addr, mem));
1928 else
1929 return_addr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO);
1931 /* Restore the old frame pointer. Emit a USE afterwards to make sure
1932 the load is preserved. */
1933 if (frame_pointer_needed)
1935 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, fp, gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, fp)));
1936 emit_use (fp);
1939 /* Deallocate the stack frame. */
1940 if (info->total_size != 0)
1942 rtx offset = frv_frame_offset_rtx (info->total_size);
1943 emit_insn (gen_stack_adjust (sp, sp, offset));
1946 /* If this function uses eh_return, add the final stack adjustment now. */
1947 if (crtl->calls_eh_return)
1948 emit_insn (gen_stack_adjust (sp, sp, EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX));
1950 if (emit_return)
1951 emit_jump_insn (gen_epilogue_return (return_addr));
1952 else
1954 rtx lr = return_addr;
1956 if (REGNO (return_addr) != LR_REGNO)
1958 lr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO);
1959 emit_move_insn (lr, return_addr);
1962 emit_use (lr);
1967 /* Worker function for TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK. */
1969 static void
1970 frv_asm_output_mi_thunk (FILE *file,
1971 tree thunk_fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1972 HOST_WIDE_INT delta,
1973 HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1974 tree function)
1976 const char *name_func = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0), 0);
1977 const char *name_arg0 = reg_names[FIRST_ARG_REGNUM];
1978 const char *name_jmp = reg_names[JUMP_REGNO];
1979 const char *parallel = (frv_issue_rate () > 1 ? ".p" : "");
1981 /* Do the add using an addi if possible. */
1982 if (IN_RANGE (delta, -2048, 2047))
1983 fprintf (file, "\taddi %s,#%d,%s\n", name_arg0, (int) delta, name_arg0);
1984 else
1986 const char *const name_add = reg_names[TEMP_REGNO];
1987 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #hi(" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "),%s\n",
1988 parallel, delta, name_add);
1989 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #lo(" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "),%s\n",
1990 delta, name_add);
1991 fprintf (file, "\tadd %s,%s,%s\n", name_add, name_arg0, name_arg0);
1994 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
1996 const char *name_pic = reg_names[FDPIC_REGNO];
1997 name_jmp = reg_names[FDPIC_FPTR_REGNO];
1999 if (flag_pic != 1)
2001 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #gotofffuncdeschi(", parallel);
2002 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2003 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
2005 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #gotofffuncdesclo(");
2006 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2007 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
2009 fprintf (file, "\tldd @(%s,%s), %s\n", name_jmp, name_pic, name_jmp);
2011 else
2013 fprintf (file, "\tlddo @(%s,#gotofffuncdesc12(", name_pic);
2014 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2015 fprintf (file, "\t)), %s\n", name_jmp);
2018 else if (!flag_pic)
2020 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #hi(", parallel);
2021 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2022 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
2024 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #lo(");
2025 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2026 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
2028 else
2030 /* Use JUMP_REGNO as a temporary PIC register. */
2031 const char *name_lr = reg_names[LR_REGNO];
2032 const char *name_gppic = name_jmp;
2033 const char *name_tmp = reg_names[TEMP_REGNO];
2035 fprintf (file, "\tmovsg %s,%s\n", name_lr, name_tmp);
2036 fprintf (file, "\tcall 1f\n");
2037 fprintf (file, "1:\tmovsg %s,%s\n", name_lr, name_gppic);
2038 fprintf (file, "\tmovgs %s,%s\n", name_tmp, name_lr);
2039 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #gprelhi(1b),%s\n", parallel, name_tmp);
2040 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #gprello(1b),%s\n", name_tmp);
2041 fprintf (file, "\tsub %s,%s,%s\n", name_gppic, name_tmp, name_gppic);
2043 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #gprelhi(", parallel);
2044 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2045 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_tmp);
2047 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #gprello(");
2048 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2049 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_tmp);
2051 fprintf (file, "\tadd %s,%s,%s\n", name_gppic, name_tmp, name_jmp);
2054 /* Jump to the function address. */
2055 fprintf (file, "\tjmpl @(%s,%s)\n", name_jmp, reg_names[GPR_FIRST+0]);
2060 /* On frv, create a frame whenever we need to create stack. */
2062 static bool
2063 frv_frame_pointer_required (void)
2065 /* If we forgoing the usual linkage requirements, we only need
2066 a frame pointer if the stack pointer might change. */
2067 if (!TARGET_LINKED_FP)
2068 return !crtl->sp_is_unchanging;
2070 if (! crtl->is_leaf)
2071 return true;
2073 if (get_frame_size () != 0)
2074 return true;
2076 if (cfun->stdarg)
2077 return true;
2079 if (!crtl->sp_is_unchanging)
2080 return true;
2082 if (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic && crtl->uses_pic_offset_table)
2083 return true;
2085 if (profile_flag)
2086 return true;
2088 if (cfun->machine->frame_needed)
2089 return true;
2091 return false;
2095 /* Worker function for TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE. */
2097 bool
2098 frv_can_eliminate (const int from, const int to)
2100 return (from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM && to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2101 ? ! frame_pointer_needed
2102 : true);
2105 /* This macro is similar to `INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET'. It specifies the
2106 initial difference between the specified pair of registers. This macro must
2107 be defined if `ELIMINABLE_REGS' is defined. */
2109 /* See frv_stack_info for more details on the frv stack frame. */
2112 frv_initial_elimination_offset (int from, int to)
2114 frv_stack_t *info = frv_stack_info ();
2115 int ret = 0;
2117 if (to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
2118 ret = info->total_size - info->pretend_size;
2120 else if (to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2121 ret = info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM];
2123 else if (to == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
2124 ret = (info->total_size
2125 - info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM]
2126 - info->pretend_size);
2128 else
2129 gcc_unreachable ();
2131 if (TARGET_DEBUG_STACK)
2132 fprintf (stderr, "Eliminate %s to %s by adding %d\n",
2133 reg_names [from], reg_names[to], ret);
2135 return ret;
2139 /* Worker function for TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS. */
2141 static void
2142 frv_setup_incoming_varargs (cumulative_args_t cum_v,
2143 enum machine_mode mode,
2144 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2145 int *pretend_size,
2146 int second_time)
2148 CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
2150 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
2151 fprintf (stderr,
2152 "setup_vararg: words = %2d, mode = %4s, pretend_size = %d, second_time = %d\n",
2153 *cum, GET_MODE_NAME (mode), *pretend_size, second_time);
2157 /* Worker function for TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS. */
2159 static rtx
2160 frv_expand_builtin_saveregs (void)
2162 int offset = UNITS_PER_WORD * FRV_NUM_ARG_REGS;
2164 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
2165 fprintf (stderr, "expand_builtin_saveregs: offset from ap = %d\n",
2166 offset);
2168 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_incoming_args_rtx, GEN_INT (- offset));
2172 /* Expand __builtin_va_start to do the va_start macro. */
2174 static void
2175 frv_expand_builtin_va_start (tree valist, rtx nextarg)
2177 tree t;
2178 int num = crtl->args.info - FIRST_ARG_REGNUM - FRV_NUM_ARG_REGS;
2180 nextarg = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
2181 GEN_INT (UNITS_PER_WORD * num));
2183 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
2185 fprintf (stderr, "va_start: args_info = %d, num = %d\n",
2186 crtl->args.info, num);
2188 debug_rtx (nextarg);
2191 t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (valist), valist,
2192 fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (valist),
2193 make_tree (sizetype, nextarg)));
2194 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1;
2196 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
2200 /* Expand a block move operation, and return 1 if successful. Return 0
2201 if we should let the compiler generate normal code.
2203 operands[0] is the destination
2204 operands[1] is the source
2205 operands[2] is the length
2206 operands[3] is the alignment */
2208 /* Maximum number of loads to do before doing the stores */
2209 #ifndef MAX_MOVE_REG
2210 #define MAX_MOVE_REG 4
2211 #endif
2213 /* Maximum number of total loads to do. */
2214 #ifndef TOTAL_MOVE_REG
2215 #define TOTAL_MOVE_REG 8
2216 #endif
2219 frv_expand_block_move (rtx operands[])
2221 rtx orig_dest = operands[0];
2222 rtx orig_src = operands[1];
2223 rtx bytes_rtx = operands[2];
2224 rtx align_rtx = operands[3];
2225 int constp = (GET_CODE (bytes_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2226 int align;
2227 int bytes;
2228 int offset;
2229 int num_reg;
2230 int i;
2231 rtx src_reg;
2232 rtx dest_reg;
2233 rtx src_addr;
2234 rtx dest_addr;
2235 rtx src_mem;
2236 rtx dest_mem;
2237 rtx tmp_reg;
2238 rtx stores[MAX_MOVE_REG];
2239 int move_bytes;
2240 enum machine_mode mode;
2242 /* If this is not a fixed size move, just call memcpy. */
2243 if (! constp)
2244 return FALSE;
2246 /* This should be a fixed size alignment. */
2247 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (align_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2249 align = INTVAL (align_rtx);
2251 /* Anything to move? */
2252 bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx);
2253 if (bytes <= 0)
2254 return TRUE;
2256 /* Don't support real large moves. */
2257 if (bytes > TOTAL_MOVE_REG*align)
2258 return FALSE;
2260 /* Move the address into scratch registers. */
2261 dest_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_dest, 0));
2262 src_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_src, 0));
2264 num_reg = offset = 0;
2265 for ( ; bytes > 0; (bytes -= move_bytes), (offset += move_bytes))
2267 /* Calculate the correct offset for src/dest. */
2268 if (offset == 0)
2270 src_addr = src_reg;
2271 dest_addr = dest_reg;
2273 else
2275 src_addr = plus_constant (Pmode, src_reg, offset);
2276 dest_addr = plus_constant (Pmode, dest_reg, offset);
2279 /* Generate the appropriate load and store, saving the stores
2280 for later. */
2281 if (bytes >= 4 && align >= 4)
2282 mode = SImode;
2283 else if (bytes >= 2 && align >= 2)
2284 mode = HImode;
2285 else
2286 mode = QImode;
2288 move_bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2289 tmp_reg = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2290 src_mem = change_address (orig_src, mode, src_addr);
2291 dest_mem = change_address (orig_dest, mode, dest_addr);
2292 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tmp_reg, src_mem));
2293 stores[num_reg++] = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest_mem, tmp_reg);
2295 if (num_reg >= MAX_MOVE_REG)
2297 for (i = 0; i < num_reg; i++)
2298 emit_insn (stores[i]);
2299 num_reg = 0;
2303 for (i = 0; i < num_reg; i++)
2304 emit_insn (stores[i]);
2306 return TRUE;
2310 /* Expand a block clear operation, and return 1 if successful. Return 0
2311 if we should let the compiler generate normal code.
2313 operands[0] is the destination
2314 operands[1] is the length
2315 operands[3] is the alignment */
2318 frv_expand_block_clear (rtx operands[])
2320 rtx orig_dest = operands[0];
2321 rtx bytes_rtx = operands[1];
2322 rtx align_rtx = operands[3];
2323 int constp = (GET_CODE (bytes_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2324 int align;
2325 int bytes;
2326 int offset;
2327 rtx dest_reg;
2328 rtx dest_addr;
2329 rtx dest_mem;
2330 int clear_bytes;
2331 enum machine_mode mode;
2333 /* If this is not a fixed size move, just call memcpy. */
2334 if (! constp)
2335 return FALSE;
2337 /* This should be a fixed size alignment. */
2338 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (align_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2340 align = INTVAL (align_rtx);
2342 /* Anything to move? */
2343 bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx);
2344 if (bytes <= 0)
2345 return TRUE;
2347 /* Don't support real large clears. */
2348 if (bytes > TOTAL_MOVE_REG*align)
2349 return FALSE;
2351 /* Move the address into a scratch register. */
2352 dest_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_dest, 0));
2354 offset = 0;
2355 for ( ; bytes > 0; (bytes -= clear_bytes), (offset += clear_bytes))
2357 /* Calculate the correct offset for src/dest. */
2358 dest_addr = ((offset == 0)
2359 ? dest_reg
2360 : plus_constant (Pmode, dest_reg, offset));
2362 /* Generate the appropriate store of gr0. */
2363 if (bytes >= 4 && align >= 4)
2364 mode = SImode;
2365 else if (bytes >= 2 && align >= 2)
2366 mode = HImode;
2367 else
2368 mode = QImode;
2370 clear_bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2371 dest_mem = change_address (orig_dest, mode, dest_addr);
2372 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest_mem, const0_rtx));
2375 return TRUE;
2379 /* The following variable is used to output modifiers of assembler
2380 code of the current output insn. */
2382 static rtx *frv_insn_operands;
2384 /* The following function is used to add assembler insn code suffix .p
2385 if it is necessary. */
2387 const char *
2388 frv_asm_output_opcode (FILE *f, const char *ptr)
2390 int c;
2392 if (frv_insn_packing_flag <= 0)
2393 return ptr;
2395 for (; *ptr && *ptr != ' ' && *ptr != '\t';)
2397 c = *ptr++;
2398 if (c == '%' && ((*ptr >= 'a' && *ptr <= 'z')
2399 || (*ptr >= 'A' && *ptr <= 'Z')))
2401 int letter = *ptr++;
2403 c = atoi (ptr);
2404 frv_print_operand (f, frv_insn_operands [c], letter);
2405 while ((c = *ptr) >= '0' && c <= '9')
2406 ptr++;
2408 else
2409 fputc (c, f);
2412 fprintf (f, ".p");
2414 return ptr;
2417 /* Set up the packing bit for the current output insn. Note that this
2418 function is not called for asm insns. */
2420 void
2421 frv_final_prescan_insn (rtx insn, rtx *opvec,
2422 int noperands ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2424 if (INSN_P (insn))
2426 if (frv_insn_packing_flag >= 0)
2428 frv_insn_operands = opvec;
2429 frv_insn_packing_flag = PACKING_FLAG_P (insn);
2431 else if (recog_memoized (insn) >= 0
2432 && get_attr_acc_group (insn) == ACC_GROUP_ODD)
2433 /* Packing optimizations have been disabled, but INSN can only
2434 be issued in M1. Insert an mnop in M0. */
2435 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmnop.p\n");
2441 /* A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack frame
2442 where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that FRAMEADDR is
2443 an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame itself.
2445 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value of
2446 FRAMEADDR--that is, the stack frame address is also the address of the stack
2447 word that points to the previous frame. */
2449 /* The default is correct, but we need to make sure the frame gets created. */
2451 frv_dynamic_chain_address (rtx frame)
2453 cfun->machine->frame_needed = 1;
2454 return frame;
2458 /* A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
2459 address for the frame COUNT steps up from the current frame, after the
2460 prologue. FRAMEADDR is the frame pointer of the COUNT frame, or the frame
2461 pointer of the COUNT - 1 frame if `RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME' is
2462 defined.
2464 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when COUNT is
2465 zero, but may be `NULL_RTX' if there is not way to determine the return
2466 address of other frames. */
2469 frv_return_addr_rtx (int count, rtx frame)
2471 if (count != 0)
2472 return const0_rtx;
2473 cfun->machine->frame_needed = 1;
2474 return gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, plus_constant (Pmode, frame, 8));
2477 /* Given a memory reference MEMREF, interpret the referenced memory as
2478 an array of MODE values, and return a reference to the element
2479 specified by INDEX. Assume that any pre-modification implicit in
2480 MEMREF has already happened.
2482 MEMREF must be a legitimate operand for modes larger than SImode.
2483 frv_legitimate_address_p forbids register+register addresses, which
2484 this function cannot handle. */
2486 frv_index_memory (rtx memref, enum machine_mode mode, int index)
2488 rtx base = XEXP (memref, 0);
2489 if (GET_CODE (base) == PRE_MODIFY)
2490 base = XEXP (base, 0);
2491 return change_address (memref, mode,
2492 plus_constant (Pmode, base,
2493 index * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)));
2497 /* Print a memory address as an operand to reference that memory location. */
2498 static void
2499 frv_print_operand_address (FILE * stream, rtx x)
2501 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
2502 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2504 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2506 case REG:
2507 fputs (reg_names [ REGNO (x)], stream);
2508 return;
2510 case CONST_INT:
2511 fprintf (stream, "%ld", (long) INTVAL (x));
2512 return;
2514 case SYMBOL_REF:
2515 assemble_name (stream, XSTR (x, 0));
2516 return;
2518 case LABEL_REF:
2519 case CONST:
2520 output_addr_const (stream, x);
2521 return;
2523 case PLUS:
2524 /* Poorly constructed asm statements can trigger this alternative.
2525 See gcc/testsuite/gcc.dg/asm-4.c for an example. */
2526 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (stream, x, 0);
2527 return;
2529 default:
2530 break;
2533 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_address:", x);
2537 static void
2538 frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg (FILE * stream, rtx x)
2540 int regno = true_regnum (x);
2541 if (GPR_P (regno))
2542 fputs (reg_names[regno], stream);
2543 else
2544 fatal_insn ("bad register to frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg:", x);
2547 /* Print a memory reference suitable for the ld/st instructions. */
2549 static void
2550 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (FILE * stream, rtx x, int addr_offset)
2552 struct frv_unspec unspec;
2553 rtx x0 = NULL_RTX;
2554 rtx x1 = NULL_RTX;
2556 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2558 case SUBREG:
2559 case REG:
2560 x0 = x;
2561 break;
2563 case PRE_MODIFY: /* (pre_modify (reg) (plus (reg) (reg))) */
2564 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
2565 x1 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1);
2566 break;
2568 case CONST_INT:
2569 x1 = x;
2570 break;
2572 case PLUS:
2573 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
2574 x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
2575 if (GET_CODE (x0) == CONST_INT)
2577 x0 = XEXP (x, 1);
2578 x1 = XEXP (x, 0);
2580 break;
2582 default:
2583 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
2584 break;
2588 if (addr_offset)
2590 if (!x1)
2591 x1 = const0_rtx;
2592 else if (GET_CODE (x1) != CONST_INT)
2593 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
2596 fputs ("@(", stream);
2597 if (!x0)
2598 fputs (reg_names[GPR_R0], stream);
2599 else if (GET_CODE (x0) == REG || GET_CODE (x0) == SUBREG)
2600 frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg (stream, x0);
2601 else
2602 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
2604 fputs (",", stream);
2605 if (!x1)
2606 fputs (reg_names [GPR_R0], stream);
2608 else
2610 switch (GET_CODE (x1))
2612 case SUBREG:
2613 case REG:
2614 frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg (stream, x1);
2615 break;
2617 case CONST_INT:
2618 fprintf (stream, "%ld", (long) (INTVAL (x1) + addr_offset));
2619 break;
2621 case CONST:
2622 if (!frv_const_unspec_p (x1, &unspec))
2623 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x1);
2624 frv_output_const_unspec (stream, &unspec);
2625 break;
2627 default:
2628 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
2632 fputs (")", stream);
2636 /* Return 2 for likely branches and 0 for non-likely branches */
2638 #define FRV_JUMP_LIKELY 2
2639 #define FRV_JUMP_NOT_LIKELY 0
2641 static int
2642 frv_print_operand_jump_hint (rtx insn)
2644 rtx note;
2645 rtx labelref;
2646 int ret;
2647 HOST_WIDE_INT prob = -1;
2648 enum { UNKNOWN, BACKWARD, FORWARD } jump_type = UNKNOWN;
2650 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN);
2652 /* Assume any non-conditional jump is likely. */
2653 if (! any_condjump_p (insn))
2654 ret = FRV_JUMP_LIKELY;
2656 else
2658 labelref = condjump_label (insn);
2659 if (labelref)
2661 rtx label = XEXP (labelref, 0);
2662 jump_type = (insn_current_address > INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (label))
2663 ? BACKWARD
2664 : FORWARD);
2667 note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_BR_PROB, 0);
2668 if (!note)
2669 ret = ((jump_type == BACKWARD) ? FRV_JUMP_LIKELY : FRV_JUMP_NOT_LIKELY);
2671 else
2673 prob = INTVAL (XEXP (note, 0));
2674 ret = ((prob >= (REG_BR_PROB_BASE / 2))
2675 ? FRV_JUMP_LIKELY
2676 : FRV_JUMP_NOT_LIKELY);
2680 #if 0
2681 if (TARGET_DEBUG)
2683 char *direction;
2685 switch (jump_type)
2687 default:
2688 case UNKNOWN: direction = "unknown jump direction"; break;
2689 case BACKWARD: direction = "jump backward"; break;
2690 case FORWARD: direction = "jump forward"; break;
2693 fprintf (stderr,
2694 "%s: uid %ld, %s, probability = %ld, max prob. = %ld, hint = %d\n",
2695 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (current_function_decl)),
2696 (long)INSN_UID (insn), direction, (long)prob,
2697 (long)REG_BR_PROB_BASE, ret);
2699 #endif
2701 return ret;
2705 /* Return the comparison operator to use for CODE given that the ICC
2706 register is OP0. */
2708 static const char *
2709 comparison_string (enum rtx_code code, rtx op0)
2711 bool is_nz_p = GET_MODE (op0) == CC_NZmode;
2712 switch (code)
2714 default: output_operand_lossage ("bad condition code");
2715 case EQ: return "eq";
2716 case NE: return "ne";
2717 case LT: return is_nz_p ? "n" : "lt";
2718 case LE: return "le";
2719 case GT: return "gt";
2720 case GE: return is_nz_p ? "p" : "ge";
2721 case LTU: return is_nz_p ? "no" : "c";
2722 case LEU: return is_nz_p ? "eq" : "ls";
2723 case GTU: return is_nz_p ? "ne" : "hi";
2724 case GEU: return is_nz_p ? "ra" : "nc";
2728 /* Print an operand to an assembler instruction.
2730 `%' followed by a letter and a digit says to output an operand in an
2731 alternate fashion. Four letters have standard, built-in meanings
2732 described below. The hook `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND' can define
2733 additional letters with nonstandard meanings.
2735 `%cDIGIT' can be used to substitute an operand that is a constant value
2736 without the syntax that normally indicates an immediate operand.
2738 `%nDIGIT' is like `%cDIGIT' except that the value of the constant is negated
2739 before printing.
2741 `%aDIGIT' can be used to substitute an operand as if it were a memory
2742 reference, with the actual operand treated as the address. This may be
2743 useful when outputting a "load address" instruction, because often the
2744 assembler syntax for such an instruction requires you to write the operand
2745 as if it were a memory reference.
2747 `%lDIGIT' is used to substitute a `label_ref' into a jump instruction.
2749 `%=' outputs a number which is unique to each instruction in the entire
2750 compilation. This is useful for making local labels to be referred to more
2751 than once in a single template that generates multiple assembler
2752 instructions.
2754 `%' followed by a punctuation character specifies a substitution that
2755 does not use an operand. Only one case is standard: `%%' outputs a
2756 `%' into the assembler code. Other nonstandard cases can be defined
2757 in the `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND' hook. You must also define which
2758 punctuation characters are valid with the
2759 `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P' hook. */
2761 static void
2762 frv_print_operand (FILE * file, rtx x, int code)
2764 struct frv_unspec unspec;
2765 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
2766 int offset;
2768 if (code != 0 && !ISALPHA (code))
2769 value = 0;
2771 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
2772 value = INTVAL (x);
2774 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
2776 if (GET_MODE (x) == SFmode)
2778 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
2779 long l;
2781 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, x);
2782 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (rv, l);
2783 value = l;
2786 else if (GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)
2787 value = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (x);
2789 else
2790 fatal_insn ("bad insn in frv_print_operand, bad const_double", x);
2793 else
2794 value = 0;
2796 switch (code)
2799 case '.':
2800 /* Output r0. */
2801 fputs (reg_names[GPR_R0], file);
2802 break;
2804 case '#':
2805 fprintf (file, "%d", frv_print_operand_jump_hint (current_output_insn));
2806 break;
2808 case '@':
2809 /* Output small data area base register (gr16). */
2810 fputs (reg_names[SDA_BASE_REG], file);
2811 break;
2813 case '~':
2814 /* Output pic register (gr17). */
2815 fputs (reg_names[PIC_REGNO], file);
2816 break;
2818 case '*':
2819 /* Output the temporary integer CCR register. */
2820 fputs (reg_names[ICR_TEMP], file);
2821 break;
2823 case '&':
2824 /* Output the temporary integer CC register. */
2825 fputs (reg_names[ICC_TEMP], file);
2826 break;
2828 /* case 'a': print an address. */
2830 case 'C':
2831 /* Print appropriate test for integer branch false operation. */
2832 fputs (comparison_string (reverse_condition (GET_CODE (x)),
2833 XEXP (x, 0)), file);
2834 break;
2836 case 'c':
2837 /* Print appropriate test for integer branch true operation. */
2838 fputs (comparison_string (GET_CODE (x), XEXP (x, 0)), file);
2839 break;
2841 case 'e':
2842 /* Print 1 for a NE and 0 for an EQ to give the final argument
2843 for a conditional instruction. */
2844 if (GET_CODE (x) == NE)
2845 fputs ("1", file);
2847 else if (GET_CODE (x) == EQ)
2848 fputs ("0", file);
2850 else
2851 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'e' modifier:", x);
2852 break;
2854 case 'F':
2855 /* Print appropriate test for floating point branch false operation. */
2856 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2858 default:
2859 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'F' modifier:", x);
2861 case EQ: fputs ("ne", file); break;
2862 case NE: fputs ("eq", file); break;
2863 case LT: fputs ("uge", file); break;
2864 case LE: fputs ("ug", file); break;
2865 case GT: fputs ("ule", file); break;
2866 case GE: fputs ("ul", file); break;
2868 break;
2870 case 'f':
2871 /* Print appropriate test for floating point branch true operation. */
2872 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2874 default:
2875 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'f' modifier:", x);
2877 case EQ: fputs ("eq", file); break;
2878 case NE: fputs ("ne", file); break;
2879 case LT: fputs ("lt", file); break;
2880 case LE: fputs ("le", file); break;
2881 case GT: fputs ("gt", file); break;
2882 case GE: fputs ("ge", file); break;
2884 break;
2886 case 'g':
2887 /* Print appropriate GOT function. */
2888 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
2889 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'g' modifier:", x);
2890 fputs (unspec_got_name (INTVAL (x)), file);
2891 break;
2893 case 'I':
2894 /* Print 'i' if the operand is a constant, or is a memory reference that
2895 adds a constant. */
2896 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
2897 x = ((GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS)
2898 ? XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)
2899 : XEXP (x, 0));
2900 else if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
2901 x = XEXP (x, 1);
2903 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2905 default:
2906 break;
2908 case CONST_INT:
2909 case SYMBOL_REF:
2910 case CONST:
2911 fputs ("i", file);
2912 break;
2914 break;
2916 case 'i':
2917 /* For jump instructions, print 'i' if the operand is a constant or
2918 is an expression that adds a constant. */
2919 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
2920 fputs ("i", file);
2922 else
2924 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
2925 || (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
2926 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
2927 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CONST_INT)))
2928 fputs ("i", file);
2930 break;
2932 case 'L':
2933 /* Print the lower register of a double word register pair */
2934 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
2935 fputs (reg_names[ REGNO (x)+1 ], file);
2936 else
2937 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'L' modifier:", x);
2938 break;
2940 /* case 'l': print a LABEL_REF. */
2942 case 'M':
2943 case 'N':
2944 /* Print a memory reference for ld/st/jmp, %N prints a memory reference
2945 for the second word of double memory operations. */
2946 offset = (code == 'M') ? 0 : UNITS_PER_WORD;
2947 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2949 default:
2950 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'M/N' modifier:", x);
2952 case MEM:
2953 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (file, XEXP (x, 0), offset);
2954 break;
2956 case REG:
2957 case SUBREG:
2958 case CONST_INT:
2959 case PLUS:
2960 case SYMBOL_REF:
2961 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (file, x, offset);
2962 break;
2964 break;
2966 case 'O':
2967 /* Print the opcode of a command. */
2968 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2970 default:
2971 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'O' modifier:", x);
2973 case PLUS: fputs ("add", file); break;
2974 case MINUS: fputs ("sub", file); break;
2975 case AND: fputs ("and", file); break;
2976 case IOR: fputs ("or", file); break;
2977 case XOR: fputs ("xor", file); break;
2978 case ASHIFT: fputs ("sll", file); break;
2979 case ASHIFTRT: fputs ("sra", file); break;
2980 case LSHIFTRT: fputs ("srl", file); break;
2982 break;
2984 /* case 'n': negate and print a constant int. */
2986 case 'P':
2987 /* Print PIC label using operand as the number. */
2988 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
2989 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, P modifier:", x);
2991 fprintf (file, ".LCF%ld", (long)INTVAL (x));
2992 break;
2994 case 'U':
2995 /* Print 'u' if the operand is a update load/store. */
2996 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PRE_MODIFY)
2997 fputs ("u", file);
2998 break;
3000 case 'z':
3001 /* If value is 0, print gr0, otherwise it must be a register. */
3002 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (x) == 0)
3003 fputs (reg_names[GPR_R0], file);
3005 else if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
3006 fputs (reg_names [REGNO (x)], file);
3008 else
3009 fatal_insn ("bad insn in frv_print_operand, z case", x);
3010 break;
3012 case 'x':
3013 /* Print constant in hex. */
3014 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
3016 fprintf (file, "%s0x%.4lx", IMMEDIATE_PREFIX, (long) value);
3017 break;
3020 /* Fall through. */
3022 case '\0':
3023 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
3024 fputs (reg_names [REGNO (x)], file);
3026 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
3027 || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
3028 fprintf (file, "%s%ld", IMMEDIATE_PREFIX, (long) value);
3030 else if (frv_const_unspec_p (x, &unspec))
3031 frv_output_const_unspec (file, &unspec);
3033 else if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
3034 frv_print_operand_address (file, XEXP (x, 0));
3036 else if (CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (x))
3037 frv_print_operand_address (file, x);
3039 else
3040 fatal_insn ("bad insn in frv_print_operand, 0 case", x);
3042 break;
3044 default:
3045 fatal_insn ("frv_print_operand: unknown code", x);
3046 break;
3049 return;
3052 static bool
3053 frv_print_operand_punct_valid_p (unsigned char code)
3055 return (code == '.' || code == '#' || code == '@' || code == '~'
3056 || code == '*' || code == '&');
3060 /* A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable CUM for the
3061 state at the beginning of the argument list. The variable has type
3062 `CUMULATIVE_ARGS'. The value of FNTYPE is the tree node for the data type
3063 of the function which will receive the args, or 0 if the args are to a
3064 compiler support library function. The value of INDIRECT is nonzero when
3065 processing an indirect call, for example a call through a function pointer.
3066 The value of INDIRECT is zero for a call to an explicitly named function, a
3067 library function call, or when `INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS' is used to find
3068 arguments for the function being compiled.
3070 When processing a call to a compiler support library function, LIBNAME
3071 identifies which one. It is a `symbol_ref' rtx which contains the name of
3072 the function, as a string. LIBNAME is 0 when an ordinary C function call is
3073 being processed. Thus, each time this macro is called, either LIBNAME or
3074 FNTYPE is nonzero, but never both of them at once. */
3076 void
3077 frv_init_cumulative_args (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum,
3078 tree fntype,
3079 rtx libname,
3080 tree fndecl,
3081 int incoming)
3083 *cum = FIRST_ARG_REGNUM;
3085 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
3087 fprintf (stderr, "\ninit_cumulative_args:");
3088 if (!fndecl && fntype)
3089 fputs (" indirect", stderr);
3091 if (incoming)
3092 fputs (" incoming", stderr);
3094 if (fntype)
3096 tree ret_type = TREE_TYPE (fntype);
3097 fprintf (stderr, " return=%s,",
3098 tree_code_name[ (int)TREE_CODE (ret_type) ]);
3101 if (libname && GET_CODE (libname) == SYMBOL_REF)
3102 fprintf (stderr, " libname=%s", XSTR (libname, 0));
3104 if (cfun->returns_struct)
3105 fprintf (stderr, " return-struct");
3107 putc ('\n', stderr);
3112 /* Return true if we should pass an argument on the stack rather than
3113 in registers. */
3115 static bool
3116 frv_must_pass_in_stack (enum machine_mode mode, const_tree type)
3118 if (mode == BLKmode)
3119 return true;
3120 if (type == NULL)
3121 return false;
3122 return AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type);
3125 /* If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits, of an
3126 argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
3127 `PARM_BOUNDARY' is used for all arguments. */
3129 static unsigned int
3130 frv_function_arg_boundary (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3131 const_tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3133 return BITS_PER_WORD;
3136 static rtx
3137 frv_function_arg_1 (cumulative_args_t cum_v, enum machine_mode mode,
3138 const_tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, bool named,
3139 bool incoming ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3141 const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
3143 enum machine_mode xmode = (mode == BLKmode) ? SImode : mode;
3144 int arg_num = *cum;
3145 rtx ret;
3146 const char *debstr;
3148 /* Return a marker for use in the call instruction. */
3149 if (xmode == VOIDmode)
3151 ret = const0_rtx;
3152 debstr = "<0>";
3155 else if (arg_num <= LAST_ARG_REGNUM)
3157 ret = gen_rtx_REG (xmode, arg_num);
3158 debstr = reg_names[arg_num];
3161 else
3163 ret = NULL_RTX;
3164 debstr = "memory";
3167 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
3168 fprintf (stderr,
3169 "function_arg: words = %2d, mode = %4s, named = %d, size = %3d, arg = %s\n",
3170 arg_num, GET_MODE_NAME (mode), named, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), debstr);
3172 return ret;
3175 static rtx
3176 frv_function_arg (cumulative_args_t cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3177 const_tree type, bool named)
3179 return frv_function_arg_1 (cum, mode, type, named, false);
3182 static rtx
3183 frv_function_incoming_arg (cumulative_args_t cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3184 const_tree type, bool named)
3186 return frv_function_arg_1 (cum, mode, type, named, true);
3190 /* A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable CUM to
3191 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values MODE, TYPE and
3192 NAMED describe that argument. Once this is done, the variable CUM is
3193 suitable for analyzing the *following* argument with `FUNCTION_ARG', etc.
3195 This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed on
3196 the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space used
3197 for arguments without any special help. */
3199 static void
3200 frv_function_arg_advance (cumulative_args_t cum_v,
3201 enum machine_mode mode,
3202 const_tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3203 bool named)
3205 CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
3207 enum machine_mode xmode = (mode == BLKmode) ? SImode : mode;
3208 int bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (xmode);
3209 int words = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3210 int arg_num = *cum;
3212 *cum = arg_num + words;
3214 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
3215 fprintf (stderr,
3216 "function_adv: words = %2d, mode = %4s, named = %d, size = %3d\n",
3217 arg_num, GET_MODE_NAME (mode), named, words * UNITS_PER_WORD);
3221 /* A C expression for the number of words, at the beginning of an argument,
3222 must be put in registers. The value must be zero for arguments that are
3223 passed entirely in registers or that are entirely pushed on the stack.
3225 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in registers
3226 and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the first N words of
3227 arguments are passed in registers, and the rest on the stack. If a
3228 multi-word argument (a `double' or a structure) crosses that boundary, its
3229 first few words must be passed in registers and the rest must be pushed.
3230 This macro tells the compiler when this occurs, and how many of the words
3231 should go in registers.
3233 `FUNCTION_ARG' for these arguments should return the first register to be
3234 used by the caller for this argument; likewise `FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG', for
3235 the called function. */
3237 static int
3238 frv_arg_partial_bytes (cumulative_args_t cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3239 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3242 enum machine_mode xmode = (mode == BLKmode) ? SImode : mode;
3243 int bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (xmode);
3244 int words = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3245 int arg_num = *get_cumulative_args (cum);
3246 int ret;
3248 ret = ((arg_num <= LAST_ARG_REGNUM && arg_num + words > LAST_ARG_REGNUM+1)
3249 ? LAST_ARG_REGNUM - arg_num + 1
3250 : 0);
3251 ret *= UNITS_PER_WORD;
3253 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG && ret)
3254 fprintf (stderr, "frv_arg_partial_bytes: %d\n", ret);
3256 return ret;
3260 /* Implements TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE. */
3262 static rtx
3263 frv_function_value (const_tree valtype,
3264 const_tree fn_decl_or_type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3265 bool outgoing ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3267 return gen_rtx_REG (TYPE_MODE (valtype), RETURN_VALUE_REGNUM);
3271 /* Implements TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE. */
3273 static rtx
3274 frv_libcall_value (enum machine_mode mode,
3275 const_rtx fun ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3277 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, RETURN_VALUE_REGNUM);
3281 /* Implements FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P. */
3283 bool
3284 frv_function_value_regno_p (const unsigned int regno)
3286 return (regno == RETURN_VALUE_REGNUM);
3289 /* Return true if a register is ok to use as a base or index register. */
3291 static FRV_INLINE int
3292 frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (int regno, int strict_p)
3294 if (GPR_P (regno))
3295 return TRUE;
3297 if (strict_p)
3298 return (reg_renumber[regno] >= 0 && GPR_P (reg_renumber[regno]));
3300 if (regno == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
3301 return TRUE;
3303 return (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
3307 /* A C compound statement with a conditional `goto LABEL;' executed if X (an
3308 RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the target machine for a memory
3309 operand of mode MODE.
3311 It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as subroutines for
3312 this one. Otherwise it may be too complicated to understand.
3314 This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a non-strict
3315 one. The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
3316 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
3317 considered a memory reference. In contexts where some kind of register is
3318 required, a pseudo-register with no hard register must be rejected.
3320 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
3321 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of register is
3322 required.
3324 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this macro
3325 define the macro `REG_OK_STRICT'. You should use an `#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT'
3326 conditional to define the strict variant in that case and the non-strict
3327 variant otherwise.
3329 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a `symbol_ref' and an
3330 integer are stored inside a `const' RTX to mark them as constant.
3331 Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums specifically as
3332 legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply recognize any `const' as
3333 legitimate.
3335 Usually `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS' is not prepared to handle
3336 constant sums that are not marked with `const'. It assumes that a
3337 naked `plus' indicates indexing. If so, then you *must* reject such
3338 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them
3339 will be given to `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS'. */
3342 frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (enum machine_mode mode,
3343 rtx x,
3344 int strict_p,
3345 int condexec_p,
3346 int allow_double_reg_p)
3348 rtx x0, x1;
3349 int ret = 0;
3350 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
3351 unsigned regno0;
3353 if (FRV_SYMBOL_REF_TLS_P (x))
3354 return 0;
3356 switch (GET_CODE (x))
3358 default:
3359 break;
3361 case SUBREG:
3362 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
3363 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
3364 break;
3366 /* Fall through. */
3368 case REG:
3369 ret = frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (x), strict_p);
3370 break;
3372 case PRE_MODIFY:
3373 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
3374 x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
3375 if (GET_CODE (x0) != REG
3376 || ! frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (x0), strict_p)
3377 || GET_CODE (x1) != PLUS
3378 || ! rtx_equal_p (x0, XEXP (x1, 0))
3379 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x1, 1)) != REG
3380 || ! frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (XEXP (x1, 1)), strict_p))
3381 break;
3383 ret = 1;
3384 break;
3386 case CONST_INT:
3387 /* 12-bit immediate */
3388 if (condexec_p)
3389 ret = FALSE;
3390 else
3392 ret = IN_RANGE (INTVAL (x), -2048, 2047);
3394 /* If we can't use load/store double operations, make sure we can
3395 address the second word. */
3396 if (ret && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
3397 ret = IN_RANGE (INTVAL (x) + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1,
3398 -2048, 2047);
3400 break;
3402 case PLUS:
3403 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
3404 x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
3406 if (GET_CODE (x0) == SUBREG)
3407 x0 = SUBREG_REG (x0);
3409 if (GET_CODE (x0) != REG)
3410 break;
3412 regno0 = REGNO (x0);
3413 if (!frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (regno0, strict_p))
3414 break;
3416 switch (GET_CODE (x1))
3418 default:
3419 break;
3421 case SUBREG:
3422 x1 = SUBREG_REG (x1);
3423 if (GET_CODE (x1) != REG)
3424 break;
3426 /* Fall through. */
3428 case REG:
3429 /* Do not allow reg+reg addressing for modes > 1 word if we
3430 can't depend on having move double instructions. */
3431 if (!allow_double_reg_p && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
3432 ret = FALSE;
3433 else
3434 ret = frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (x1), strict_p);
3435 break;
3437 case CONST_INT:
3438 /* 12-bit immediate */
3439 if (condexec_p)
3440 ret = FALSE;
3441 else
3443 value = INTVAL (x1);
3444 ret = IN_RANGE (value, -2048, 2047);
3446 /* If we can't use load/store double operations, make sure we can
3447 address the second word. */
3448 if (ret && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
3449 ret = IN_RANGE (value + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1, -2048, 2047);
3451 break;
3453 case CONST:
3454 if (!condexec_p && got12_operand (x1, VOIDmode))
3455 ret = TRUE;
3456 break;
3459 break;
3462 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ADDR)
3464 fprintf (stderr, "\n========== legitimate_address_p, mode = %s, result = %d, addresses are %sstrict%s\n",
3465 GET_MODE_NAME (mode), ret, (strict_p) ? "" : "not ",
3466 (condexec_p) ? ", inside conditional code" : "");
3467 debug_rtx (x);
3470 return ret;
3473 bool
3474 frv_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, bool strict_p)
3476 return frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (mode, x, strict_p, FALSE, FALSE);
3479 /* Given an ADDR, generate code to inline the PLT. */
3480 static rtx
3481 gen_inlined_tls_plt (rtx addr)
3483 rtx retval, dest;
3484 rtx picreg = get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, FDPIC_REG);
3487 dest = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3489 if (flag_pic == 1)
3492 -fpic version:
3494 lddi.p @(gr15, #gottlsdesc12(ADDR)), gr8
3495 calll #gettlsoff(ADDR)@(gr8, gr0)
3497 emit_insn (gen_tls_lddi (dest, addr, picreg));
3499 else
3502 -fPIC version:
3504 sethi.p #gottlsdeschi(ADDR), gr8
3505 setlo #gottlsdesclo(ADDR), gr8
3506 ldd #tlsdesc(ADDR)@(gr15, gr8), gr8
3507 calll #gettlsoff(ADDR)@(gr8, gr0)
3509 rtx reguse = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3510 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (reguse, addr, GEN_INT (R_FRV_GOTTLSDESCHI)));
3511 emit_insn (gen_tls_tlsdesc_ldd (dest, picreg, reguse, addr));
3514 retval = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3515 emit_insn (gen_tls_indirect_call (retval, addr, dest, picreg));
3516 return retval;
3519 /* Emit a TLSMOFF or TLSMOFF12 offset, depending on -mTLS. Returns
3520 the destination address. */
3521 static rtx
3522 gen_tlsmoff (rtx addr, rtx reg)
3524 rtx dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3526 if (TARGET_BIG_TLS)
3528 /* sethi.p #tlsmoffhi(x), grA
3529 setlo #tlsmofflo(x), grA
3531 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3532 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (dest, addr,
3533 GEN_INT (R_FRV_TLSMOFFHI)));
3534 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, dest, reg);
3536 else
3538 /* addi grB, #tlsmoff12(x), grC
3539 -or-
3540 ld/st @(grB, #tlsmoff12(x)), grC
3542 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3543 emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg_i (dest, addr, reg,
3544 GEN_INT (R_FRV_TLSMOFF12)));
3546 return dest;
3549 /* Generate code for a TLS address. */
3550 static rtx
3551 frv_legitimize_tls_address (rtx addr, enum tls_model model)
3553 rtx dest, tp = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 29);
3554 rtx picreg = get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, 15);
3556 switch (model)
3558 case TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC:
3559 if (flag_pic == 1)
3561 /* -fpic version.
3562 ldi @(gr15, #gottlsoff12(x)), gr5
3564 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3565 emit_insn (gen_tls_load_gottlsoff12 (dest, addr, picreg));
3566 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, dest);
3568 else
3570 /* -fPIC or anything else.
3572 sethi.p #gottlsoffhi(x), gr14
3573 setlo #gottlsofflo(x), gr14
3574 ld #tlsoff(x)@(gr15, gr14), gr9
3576 rtx tmp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3577 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3578 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (tmp, addr,
3579 GEN_INT (R_FRV_GOTTLSOFF_HI)));
3581 emit_insn (gen_tls_tlsoff_ld (dest, picreg, tmp, addr));
3582 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, dest);
3584 break;
3585 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC:
3587 rtx reg, retval;
3589 if (TARGET_INLINE_PLT)
3590 retval = gen_inlined_tls_plt (GEN_INT (0));
3591 else
3593 /* call #gettlsoff(0) */
3594 retval = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3595 emit_insn (gen_call_gettlsoff (retval, GEN_INT (0), picreg));
3598 reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3599 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg,
3600 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
3601 retval, tp)));
3603 dest = gen_tlsmoff (addr, reg);
3606 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3607 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (dest, addr,
3608 GEN_INT (R_FRV_TLSMOFFHI)));
3609 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, dest, reg);
3611 break;
3613 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC:
3614 dest = gen_tlsmoff (addr, gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 29));
3615 break;
3616 case TLS_MODEL_GLOBAL_DYNAMIC:
3618 rtx retval;
3620 if (TARGET_INLINE_PLT)
3621 retval = gen_inlined_tls_plt (addr);
3622 else
3624 /* call #gettlsoff(x) */
3625 retval = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3626 emit_insn (gen_call_gettlsoff (retval, addr, picreg));
3628 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, retval, tp);
3629 break;
3631 default:
3632 gcc_unreachable ();
3635 return dest;
3639 frv_legitimize_address (rtx x,
3640 rtx oldx ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3641 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3643 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF)
3645 enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (x);
3646 if (model != 0)
3647 return frv_legitimize_tls_address (x, model);
3650 return x;
3653 /* Test whether a local function descriptor is canonical, i.e.,
3654 whether we can use FUNCDESC_GOTOFF to compute the address of the
3655 function. */
3657 static bool
3658 frv_local_funcdesc_p (rtx fnx)
3660 tree fn;
3661 enum symbol_visibility vis;
3662 bool ret;
3664 if (! SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (fnx))
3665 return FALSE;
3667 fn = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (fnx);
3669 if (! fn)
3670 return FALSE;
3672 vis = DECL_VISIBILITY (fn);
3674 if (vis == VISIBILITY_PROTECTED)
3675 /* Private function descriptors for protected functions are not
3676 canonical. Temporarily change the visibility to global. */
3677 vis = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
3678 else if (flag_shlib)
3679 /* If we're already compiling for a shared library (that, unlike
3680 executables, can't assume that the existence of a definition
3681 implies local binding), we can skip the re-testing. */
3682 return TRUE;
3684 ret = default_binds_local_p_1 (fn, flag_pic);
3686 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = vis;
3688 return ret;
3691 /* Load the _gp symbol into DEST. SRC is supposed to be the FDPIC
3692 register. */
3695 frv_gen_GPsym2reg (rtx dest, rtx src)
3697 tree gp = get_identifier ("_gp");
3698 rtx gp_sym = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (gp));
3700 return gen_symGOT2reg (dest, gp_sym, src, GEN_INT (R_FRV_GOT12));
3703 static const char *
3704 unspec_got_name (int i)
3706 switch (i)
3708 case R_FRV_GOT12: return "got12";
3709 case R_FRV_GOTHI: return "gothi";
3710 case R_FRV_GOTLO: return "gotlo";
3711 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC: return "funcdesc";
3712 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOT12: return "gotfuncdesc12";
3713 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTHI: return "gotfuncdeschi";
3714 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTLO: return "gotfuncdesclo";
3715 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_VALUE: return "funcdescvalue";
3716 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12: return "gotofffuncdesc12";
3717 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFFHI: return "gotofffuncdeschi";
3718 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFFLO: return "gotofffuncdesclo";
3719 case R_FRV_GOTOFF12: return "gotoff12";
3720 case R_FRV_GOTOFFHI: return "gotoffhi";
3721 case R_FRV_GOTOFFLO: return "gotofflo";
3722 case R_FRV_GPREL12: return "gprel12";
3723 case R_FRV_GPRELHI: return "gprelhi";
3724 case R_FRV_GPRELLO: return "gprello";
3725 case R_FRV_GOTTLSOFF_HI: return "gottlsoffhi";
3726 case R_FRV_GOTTLSOFF_LO: return "gottlsofflo";
3727 case R_FRV_TLSMOFFHI: return "tlsmoffhi";
3728 case R_FRV_TLSMOFFLO: return "tlsmofflo";
3729 case R_FRV_TLSMOFF12: return "tlsmoff12";
3730 case R_FRV_TLSDESCHI: return "tlsdeschi";
3731 case R_FRV_TLSDESCLO: return "tlsdesclo";
3732 case R_FRV_GOTTLSDESCHI: return "gottlsdeschi";
3733 case R_FRV_GOTTLSDESCLO: return "gottlsdesclo";
3734 default: gcc_unreachable ();
3738 /* Write the assembler syntax for UNSPEC to STREAM. Note that any offset
3739 is added inside the relocation operator. */
3741 static void
3742 frv_output_const_unspec (FILE *stream, const struct frv_unspec *unspec)
3744 fprintf (stream, "#%s(", unspec_got_name (unspec->reloc));
3745 output_addr_const (stream, plus_constant (Pmode, unspec->symbol,
3746 unspec->offset));
3747 fputs (")", stream);
3750 /* Implement FIND_BASE_TERM. See whether ORIG_X represents #gprel12(foo)
3751 or #gotoff12(foo) for some small data symbol foo. If so, return foo,
3752 otherwise return ORIG_X. */
3755 frv_find_base_term (rtx x)
3757 struct frv_unspec unspec;
3759 if (frv_const_unspec_p (x, &unspec)
3760 && frv_small_data_reloc_p (unspec.symbol, unspec.reloc))
3761 return plus_constant (Pmode, unspec.symbol, unspec.offset);
3763 return x;
3766 /* Return 1 if operand is a valid FRV address. CONDEXEC_P is true if
3767 the operand is used by a predicated instruction. */
3770 frv_legitimate_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode, int condexec_p)
3772 return ((GET_MODE (op) == mode || mode == VOIDmode)
3773 && GET_CODE (op) == MEM
3774 && frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (mode, XEXP (op, 0),
3775 reload_completed, condexec_p, FALSE));
3778 void
3779 frv_expand_fdpic_call (rtx *operands, bool ret_value, bool sibcall)
3781 rtx lr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO);
3782 rtx picreg = get_hard_reg_initial_val (SImode, FDPIC_REG);
3783 rtx c, rvrtx=0;
3784 rtx addr;
3786 if (ret_value)
3788 rvrtx = operands[0];
3789 operands ++;
3792 addr = XEXP (operands[0], 0);
3794 /* Inline PLTs if we're optimizing for speed. We'd like to inline
3795 any calls that would involve a PLT, but can't tell, since we
3796 don't know whether an extern function is going to be provided by
3797 a separate translation unit or imported from a separate module.
3798 When compiling for shared libraries, if the function has default
3799 visibility, we assume it's overridable, so we inline the PLT, but
3800 for executables, we don't really have a way to make a good
3801 decision: a function is as likely to be imported from a shared
3802 library as it is to be defined in the executable itself. We
3803 assume executables will get global functions defined locally,
3804 whereas shared libraries will have them potentially overridden,
3805 so we only inline PLTs when compiling for shared libraries.
3807 In order to mark a function as local to a shared library, any
3808 non-default visibility attribute suffices. Unfortunately,
3809 there's no simple way to tag a function declaration as ``in a
3810 different module'', which we could then use to trigger PLT
3811 inlining on executables. There's -minline-plt, but it affects
3812 all external functions, so one would have to also mark function
3813 declarations available in the same module with non-default
3814 visibility, which is advantageous in itself. */
3815 if (GET_CODE (addr) == SYMBOL_REF
3816 && ((!SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (addr) && TARGET_INLINE_PLT)
3817 || sibcall))
3819 rtx x, dest;
3820 dest = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
3821 if (flag_pic != 1)
3822 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, addr, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
3823 GEN_INT (R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12));
3824 else
3825 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, addr, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
3826 GEN_INT (R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12));
3827 emit_insn (x);
3828 crtl->uses_pic_offset_table = TRUE;
3829 addr = dest;
3831 else if (GET_CODE (addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
3833 /* These are always either local, or handled through a local
3834 PLT. */
3835 if (ret_value)
3836 c = gen_call_value_fdpicsi (rvrtx, addr, operands[1],
3837 operands[2], picreg, lr);
3838 else
3839 c = gen_call_fdpicsi (addr, operands[1], operands[2], picreg, lr);
3840 emit_call_insn (c);
3841 return;
3843 else if (! ldd_address_operand (addr, Pmode))
3844 addr = force_reg (Pmode, addr);
3846 picreg = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3847 emit_insn (gen_movdi_ldd (picreg, addr));
3849 if (sibcall && ret_value)
3850 c = gen_sibcall_value_fdpicdi (rvrtx, picreg, const0_rtx);
3851 else if (sibcall)
3852 c = gen_sibcall_fdpicdi (picreg, const0_rtx);
3853 else if (ret_value)
3854 c = gen_call_value_fdpicdi (rvrtx, picreg, const0_rtx, lr);
3855 else
3856 c = gen_call_fdpicdi (picreg, const0_rtx, lr);
3857 emit_call_insn (c);
3860 /* Look for a SYMBOL_REF of a function in an rtx. We always want to
3861 process these separately from any offsets, such that we add any
3862 offsets to the function descriptor (the actual pointer), not to the
3863 function address. */
3865 static bool
3866 frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (rtx x)
3868 const char *format;
3869 int length;
3870 int j;
3872 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF)
3873 return SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (x);
3875 length = GET_RTX_LENGTH (GET_CODE (x));
3876 format = GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (x));
3878 for (j = 0; j < length; ++j)
3880 switch (format[j])
3882 case 'e':
3883 if (frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (XEXP (x, j)))
3884 return TRUE;
3885 break;
3887 case 'V':
3888 case 'E':
3889 if (XVEC (x, j) != 0)
3891 int k;
3892 for (k = 0; k < XVECLEN (x, j); ++k)
3893 if (frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (XVECEXP (x, j, k)))
3894 return TRUE;
3896 break;
3898 default:
3899 /* Nothing to do. */
3900 break;
3904 return FALSE;
3907 /* Return true if the memory operand is one that can be conditionally
3908 executed. */
3911 condexec_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
3913 enum machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (op);
3914 rtx addr;
3916 if (mode != VOIDmode && op_mode != mode)
3917 return FALSE;
3919 switch (op_mode)
3921 default:
3922 return FALSE;
3924 case QImode:
3925 case HImode:
3926 case SImode:
3927 case SFmode:
3928 break;
3931 if (GET_CODE (op) != MEM)
3932 return FALSE;
3934 addr = XEXP (op, 0);
3935 return frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (mode, addr, reload_completed, TRUE, FALSE);
3938 /* Return true if the bare return instruction can be used outside of the
3939 epilog code. For frv, we only do it if there was no stack allocation. */
3942 direct_return_p (void)
3944 frv_stack_t *info;
3946 if (!reload_completed)
3947 return FALSE;
3949 info = frv_stack_info ();
3950 return (info->total_size == 0);
3954 void
3955 frv_emit_move (enum machine_mode mode, rtx dest, rtx src)
3957 if (GET_CODE (src) == SYMBOL_REF)
3959 enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (src);
3960 if (model != 0)
3961 src = frv_legitimize_tls_address (src, model);
3964 switch (mode)
3966 case SImode:
3967 if (frv_emit_movsi (dest, src))
3968 return;
3969 break;
3971 case QImode:
3972 case HImode:
3973 case DImode:
3974 case SFmode:
3975 case DFmode:
3976 if (!reload_in_progress
3977 && !reload_completed
3978 && !register_operand (dest, mode)
3979 && !reg_or_0_operand (src, mode))
3980 src = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, src);
3981 break;
3983 default:
3984 gcc_unreachable ();
3987 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src));
3990 /* Emit code to handle a MOVSI, adding in the small data register or pic
3991 register if needed to load up addresses. Return TRUE if the appropriate
3992 instructions are emitted. */
3995 frv_emit_movsi (rtx dest, rtx src)
3997 int base_regno = -1;
3998 int unspec = 0;
3999 rtx sym = src;
4000 struct frv_unspec old_unspec;
4002 if (!reload_in_progress
4003 && !reload_completed
4004 && !register_operand (dest, SImode)
4005 && (!reg_or_0_operand (src, SImode)
4006 /* Virtual registers will almost always be replaced by an
4007 add instruction, so expose this to CSE by copying to
4008 an intermediate register. */
4009 || (GET_CODE (src) == REG
4010 && IN_RANGE (REGNO (src),
4011 FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER,
4012 LAST_VIRTUAL_POINTER_REGISTER))))
4014 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, copy_to_mode_reg (SImode, src)));
4015 return TRUE;
4018 /* Explicitly add in the PIC or small data register if needed. */
4019 switch (GET_CODE (src))
4021 default:
4022 break;
4024 case LABEL_REF:
4025 handle_label:
4026 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
4028 /* Using GPREL12, we use a single GOT entry for all symbols
4029 in read-only sections, but trade sequences such as:
4031 sethi #gothi(label), gr#
4032 setlo #gotlo(label), gr#
4033 ld @(gr15,gr#), gr#
4037 ld @(gr15,#got12(_gp)), gr#
4038 sethi #gprelhi(label), gr##
4039 setlo #gprello(label), gr##
4040 add gr#, gr##, gr##
4042 We may often be able to share gr# for multiple
4043 computations of GPREL addresses, and we may often fold
4044 the final add into the pair of registers of a load or
4045 store instruction, so it's often profitable. Even when
4046 optimizing for size, we're trading a GOT entry for an
4047 additional instruction, which trades GOT space
4048 (read-write) for code size (read-only, shareable), as
4049 long as the symbol is not used in more than two different
4050 locations.
4052 With -fpie/-fpic, we'd be trading a single load for a
4053 sequence of 4 instructions, because the offset of the
4054 label can't be assumed to be addressable with 12 bits, so
4055 we don't do this. */
4056 if (TARGET_GPREL_RO)
4057 unspec = R_FRV_GPREL12;
4058 else
4059 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4061 else if (flag_pic)
4062 base_regno = PIC_REGNO;
4064 break;
4066 case CONST:
4067 if (frv_const_unspec_p (src, &old_unspec))
4068 break;
4070 if (TARGET_FDPIC && frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (XEXP (src, 0)))
4072 handle_whatever:
4073 src = force_reg (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)), XEXP (src, 0));
4074 emit_move_insn (dest, src);
4075 return TRUE;
4077 else
4079 sym = XEXP (sym, 0);
4080 if (GET_CODE (sym) == PLUS
4081 && GET_CODE (XEXP (sym, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
4082 && GET_CODE (XEXP (sym, 1)) == CONST_INT)
4083 sym = XEXP (sym, 0);
4084 if (GET_CODE (sym) == SYMBOL_REF)
4085 goto handle_sym;
4086 else if (GET_CODE (sym) == LABEL_REF)
4087 goto handle_label;
4088 else
4089 goto handle_whatever;
4091 break;
4093 case SYMBOL_REF:
4094 handle_sym:
4095 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
4097 enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (sym);
4099 if (model != 0)
4101 src = frv_legitimize_tls_address (src, model);
4102 emit_move_insn (dest, src);
4103 return TRUE;
4106 if (SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (sym))
4108 if (frv_local_funcdesc_p (sym))
4109 unspec = R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12;
4110 else
4111 unspec = R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOT12;
4113 else
4115 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (sym))
4116 switch (GET_CODE (get_pool_constant (sym)))
4118 case CONST:
4119 case SYMBOL_REF:
4120 case LABEL_REF:
4121 if (flag_pic)
4123 unspec = R_FRV_GOTOFF12;
4124 break;
4126 /* Fall through. */
4127 default:
4128 if (TARGET_GPREL_RO)
4129 unspec = R_FRV_GPREL12;
4130 else
4131 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4132 break;
4134 else if (SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (sym)
4135 && !SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (sym)
4136 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym)
4137 && (!DECL_P (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym))
4138 || !DECL_COMMON (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym))))
4140 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym);
4141 tree init = TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
4142 ? DECL_INITIAL (decl)
4143 : TREE_CODE (decl) == CONSTRUCTOR
4144 ? decl : 0;
4145 int reloc = 0;
4146 bool named_section, readonly;
4148 if (init && init != error_mark_node)
4149 reloc = compute_reloc_for_constant (init);
4151 named_section = TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
4152 && lookup_attribute ("section", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl));
4153 readonly = decl_readonly_section (decl, reloc);
4155 if (named_section)
4156 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4157 else if (!readonly)
4158 unspec = R_FRV_GOTOFF12;
4159 else if (readonly && TARGET_GPREL_RO)
4160 unspec = R_FRV_GPREL12;
4161 else
4162 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4164 else
4165 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4169 else if (SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (sym))
4170 base_regno = SDA_BASE_REG;
4172 else if (flag_pic)
4173 base_regno = PIC_REGNO;
4175 break;
4178 if (base_regno >= 0)
4180 if (GET_CODE (sym) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (sym))
4181 emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, src,
4182 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base_regno),
4183 GEN_INT (R_FRV_GPREL12)));
4184 else
4185 emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, src,
4186 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base_regno),
4187 GEN_INT (R_FRV_GPREL12)));
4188 if (base_regno == PIC_REGNO)
4189 crtl->uses_pic_offset_table = TRUE;
4190 return TRUE;
4193 if (unspec)
4195 rtx x;
4197 /* Since OUR_FDPIC_REG is a pseudo register, we can't safely introduce
4198 new uses of it once reload has begun. */
4199 gcc_assert (!reload_in_progress && !reload_completed);
4201 switch (unspec)
4203 case R_FRV_GOTOFF12:
4204 if (!frv_small_data_reloc_p (sym, unspec))
4205 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4206 GEN_INT (unspec));
4207 else
4208 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4209 break;
4210 case R_FRV_GPREL12:
4211 if (!frv_small_data_reloc_p (sym, unspec))
4212 x = gen_symGPREL2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4213 GEN_INT (unspec));
4214 else
4215 x = gen_symGPREL2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4216 break;
4217 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12:
4218 if (flag_pic != 1)
4219 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4220 GEN_INT (unspec));
4221 else
4222 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4223 break;
4224 default:
4225 if (flag_pic != 1)
4226 x = gen_symGOT2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4227 GEN_INT (unspec));
4228 else
4229 x = gen_symGOT2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4230 break;
4232 emit_insn (x);
4233 crtl->uses_pic_offset_table = TRUE;
4234 return TRUE;
4238 return FALSE;
4242 /* Return a string to output a single word move. */
4244 const char *
4245 output_move_single (rtx operands[], rtx insn)
4247 rtx dest = operands[0];
4248 rtx src = operands[1];
4250 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
4252 int dest_regno = REGNO (dest);
4253 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4255 if (GPR_P (dest_regno))
4257 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4259 /* gpr <- some sort of register */
4260 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4262 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4263 return "mov %1, %0";
4265 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4266 return "movfg %1, %0";
4268 else if (SPR_P (src_regno))
4269 return "movsg %1, %0";
4272 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4274 /* gpr <- memory */
4275 switch (mode)
4277 default:
4278 break;
4280 case QImode:
4281 return "ldsb%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4283 case HImode:
4284 return "ldsh%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4286 case SImode:
4287 case SFmode:
4288 return "ld%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4292 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT
4293 || GET_CODE (src) == CONST_DOUBLE)
4295 /* gpr <- integer/floating constant */
4296 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
4298 if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT)
4299 value = INTVAL (src);
4301 else if (mode == SFmode)
4303 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
4304 long l;
4306 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, src);
4307 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (rv, l);
4308 value = l;
4311 else
4312 value = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (src);
4314 if (IN_RANGE (value, -32768, 32767))
4315 return "setlos %1, %0";
4317 return "#";
4320 else if (GET_CODE (src) == SYMBOL_REF
4321 || GET_CODE (src) == LABEL_REF
4322 || GET_CODE (src) == CONST)
4324 return "#";
4328 else if (FPR_P (dest_regno))
4330 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4332 /* fpr <- some sort of register */
4333 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4335 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4336 return "movgf %1, %0";
4338 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4340 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
4341 return "fmovs %1, %0";
4342 else
4343 return "mor %1, %1, %0";
4347 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4349 /* fpr <- memory */
4350 switch (mode)
4352 default:
4353 break;
4355 case QImode:
4356 return "ldbf%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4358 case HImode:
4359 return "ldhf%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4361 case SImode:
4362 case SFmode:
4363 return "ldf%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4367 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4368 return "movgf %., %0";
4371 else if (SPR_P (dest_regno))
4373 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4375 /* spr <- some sort of register */
4376 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4378 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4379 return "movgs %1, %0";
4381 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4382 return "movgs %., %0";
4386 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
4388 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4390 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4391 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4393 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4395 switch (mode)
4397 default:
4398 break;
4400 case QImode:
4401 return "stb%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4403 case HImode:
4404 return "sth%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4406 case SImode:
4407 case SFmode:
4408 return "st%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4412 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4414 switch (mode)
4416 default:
4417 break;
4419 case QImode:
4420 return "stbf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4422 case HImode:
4423 return "sthf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4425 case SImode:
4426 case SFmode:
4427 return "stf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4432 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4434 switch (GET_MODE (dest))
4436 default:
4437 break;
4439 case QImode:
4440 return "stb%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4442 case HImode:
4443 return "sth%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4445 case SImode:
4446 case SFmode:
4447 return "st%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4452 fatal_insn ("bad output_move_single operand", insn);
4453 return "";
4457 /* Return a string to output a double word move. */
4459 const char *
4460 output_move_double (rtx operands[], rtx insn)
4462 rtx dest = operands[0];
4463 rtx src = operands[1];
4464 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4466 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
4468 int dest_regno = REGNO (dest);
4470 if (GPR_P (dest_regno))
4472 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4474 /* gpr <- some sort of register */
4475 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4477 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4478 return "#";
4480 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4482 if (((dest_regno - GPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4483 && ((src_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0)
4484 return "movfgd %1, %0";
4486 return "#";
4490 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4492 /* gpr <- memory */
4493 if (dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (src, mode))
4494 return "ldd%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4496 return "#";
4499 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT
4500 || GET_CODE (src) == CONST_DOUBLE)
4501 return "#";
4504 else if (FPR_P (dest_regno))
4506 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4508 /* fpr <- some sort of register */
4509 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4511 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4513 if (((dest_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4514 && ((src_regno - GPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0)
4515 return "movgfd %1, %0";
4517 return "#";
4520 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4522 if (TARGET_DOUBLE
4523 && ((dest_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4524 && ((src_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0)
4525 return "fmovd %1, %0";
4527 return "#";
4531 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4533 /* fpr <- memory */
4534 if (dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (src, mode))
4535 return "lddf%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4537 return "#";
4540 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4541 return "#";
4545 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
4547 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4549 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4551 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4553 if (((src_regno - GPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4554 && dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (dest, mode))
4555 return "std%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4557 return "#";
4560 if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4562 if (((src_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4563 && dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (dest, mode))
4564 return "stdf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4566 return "#";
4570 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4572 if (dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (dest, mode))
4573 return "std%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4575 return "#";
4579 fatal_insn ("bad output_move_double operand", insn);
4580 return "";
4584 /* Return a string to output a single word conditional move.
4585 Operand0 -- EQ/NE of ccr register and 0
4586 Operand1 -- CCR register
4587 Operand2 -- destination
4588 Operand3 -- source */
4590 const char *
4591 output_condmove_single (rtx operands[], rtx insn)
4593 rtx dest = operands[2];
4594 rtx src = operands[3];
4596 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
4598 int dest_regno = REGNO (dest);
4599 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4601 if (GPR_P (dest_regno))
4603 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4605 /* gpr <- some sort of register */
4606 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4608 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4609 return "cmov %z3, %2, %1, %e0";
4611 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4612 return "cmovfg %3, %2, %1, %e0";
4615 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4617 /* gpr <- memory */
4618 switch (mode)
4620 default:
4621 break;
4623 case QImode:
4624 return "cldsb%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4626 case HImode:
4627 return "cldsh%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4629 case SImode:
4630 case SFmode:
4631 return "cld%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4635 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4636 return "cmov %., %2, %1, %e0";
4639 else if (FPR_P (dest_regno))
4641 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4643 /* fpr <- some sort of register */
4644 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4646 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4647 return "cmovgf %3, %2, %1, %e0";
4649 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4651 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
4652 return "cfmovs %3,%2,%1,%e0";
4653 else
4654 return "cmor %3, %3, %2, %1, %e0";
4658 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4660 /* fpr <- memory */
4661 if (mode == SImode || mode == SFmode)
4662 return "cldf%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4665 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4666 return "cmovgf %., %2, %1, %e0";
4670 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
4672 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4674 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4675 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4677 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4679 switch (mode)
4681 default:
4682 break;
4684 case QImode:
4685 return "cstb%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4687 case HImode:
4688 return "csth%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4690 case SImode:
4691 case SFmode:
4692 return "cst%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4696 else if (FPR_P (src_regno) && (mode == SImode || mode == SFmode))
4697 return "cstf%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4700 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4702 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4703 switch (mode)
4705 default:
4706 break;
4708 case QImode:
4709 return "cstb%I2%U2 %., %M2, %1, %e0";
4711 case HImode:
4712 return "csth%I2%U2 %., %M2, %1, %e0";
4714 case SImode:
4715 case SFmode:
4716 return "cst%I2%U2 %., %M2, %1, %e0";
4721 fatal_insn ("bad output_condmove_single operand", insn);
4722 return "";
4726 /* Emit the appropriate code to do a comparison, returning the register the
4727 comparison was done it. */
4729 static rtx
4730 frv_emit_comparison (enum rtx_code test, rtx op0, rtx op1)
4732 enum machine_mode cc_mode;
4733 rtx cc_reg;
4735 /* Floating point doesn't have comparison against a constant. */
4736 if (GET_MODE (op0) == CC_FPmode && GET_CODE (op1) != REG)
4737 op1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op1);
4739 /* Possibly disable using anything but a fixed register in order to work
4740 around cse moving comparisons past function calls. */
4741 cc_mode = SELECT_CC_MODE (test, op0, op1);
4742 cc_reg = ((TARGET_ALLOC_CC)
4743 ? gen_reg_rtx (cc_mode)
4744 : gen_rtx_REG (cc_mode,
4745 (cc_mode == CC_FPmode) ? FCC_FIRST : ICC_FIRST));
4747 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, cc_reg,
4748 gen_rtx_COMPARE (cc_mode, op0, op1)));
4750 return cc_reg;
4754 /* Emit code for a conditional branch.
4755 XXX: I originally wanted to add a clobber of a CCR register to use in
4756 conditional execution, but that confuses the rest of the compiler. */
4759 frv_emit_cond_branch (rtx operands[])
4761 rtx test_rtx;
4762 rtx label_ref;
4763 rtx if_else;
4764 enum rtx_code test = GET_CODE (operands[0]);
4765 rtx cc_reg = frv_emit_comparison (test, operands[1], operands[2]);
4766 enum machine_mode cc_mode = GET_MODE (cc_reg);
4768 /* Branches generate:
4769 (set (pc)
4770 (if_then_else (<test>, <cc_reg>, (const_int 0))
4771 (label_ref <branch_label>)
4772 (pc))) */
4773 label_ref = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode, operands[3]);
4774 test_rtx = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test, cc_mode, cc_reg, const0_rtx);
4775 if_else = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (cc_mode, test_rtx, label_ref, pc_rtx);
4776 emit_jump_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, pc_rtx, if_else));
4777 return TRUE;
4781 /* Emit code to set a gpr to 1/0 based on a comparison. */
4784 frv_emit_scc (rtx operands[])
4786 rtx set;
4787 rtx test_rtx;
4788 rtx clobber;
4789 rtx cr_reg;
4790 enum rtx_code test = GET_CODE (operands[1]);
4791 rtx cc_reg = frv_emit_comparison (test, operands[2], operands[3]);
4793 /* SCC instructions generate:
4794 (parallel [(set <target> (<test>, <cc_reg>, (const_int 0))
4795 (clobber (<ccr_reg>))]) */
4796 test_rtx = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test, SImode, cc_reg, const0_rtx);
4797 set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, operands[0], test_rtx);
4799 cr_reg = ((TARGET_ALLOC_CC)
4800 ? gen_reg_rtx (CC_CCRmode)
4801 : gen_rtx_REG (CC_CCRmode,
4802 ((GET_MODE (cc_reg) == CC_FPmode)
4803 ? FCR_FIRST
4804 : ICR_FIRST)));
4806 clobber = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, cr_reg);
4807 emit_insn (gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, gen_rtvec (2, set, clobber)));
4808 return TRUE;
4812 /* Split a SCC instruction into component parts, returning a SEQUENCE to hold
4813 the separate insns. */
4816 frv_split_scc (rtx dest, rtx test, rtx cc_reg, rtx cr_reg, HOST_WIDE_INT value)
4818 rtx ret;
4820 start_sequence ();
4822 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
4823 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
4824 cr_reg,
4825 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (test),
4826 GET_MODE (cr_reg),
4827 cc_reg,
4828 const0_rtx)));
4830 /* Move the value into the destination. */
4831 emit_move_insn (dest, GEN_INT (value));
4833 /* Move 0 into the destination if the test failed */
4834 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4835 gen_rtx_EQ (GET_MODE (cr_reg),
4836 cr_reg,
4837 const0_rtx),
4838 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, const0_rtx)));
4840 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
4841 ret = get_insns ();
4842 end_sequence ();
4843 return ret;
4847 /* Emit the code for a conditional move, return TRUE if we could do the
4848 move. */
4851 frv_emit_cond_move (rtx dest, rtx test_rtx, rtx src1, rtx src2)
4853 rtx set;
4854 rtx clobber_cc;
4855 rtx test2;
4856 rtx cr_reg;
4857 rtx if_rtx;
4858 enum rtx_code test = GET_CODE (test_rtx);
4859 rtx cc_reg = frv_emit_comparison (test,
4860 XEXP (test_rtx, 0), XEXP (test_rtx, 1));
4861 enum machine_mode cc_mode = GET_MODE (cc_reg);
4863 /* Conditional move instructions generate:
4864 (parallel [(set <target>
4865 (if_then_else (<test> <cc_reg> (const_int 0))
4866 <src1>
4867 <src2>))
4868 (clobber (<ccr_reg>))]) */
4870 /* Handle various cases of conditional move involving two constants. */
4871 if (GET_CODE (src1) == CONST_INT && GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT)
4873 HOST_WIDE_INT value1 = INTVAL (src1);
4874 HOST_WIDE_INT value2 = INTVAL (src2);
4876 /* Having 0 as one of the constants can be done by loading the other
4877 constant, and optionally moving in gr0. */
4878 if (value1 == 0 || value2 == 0)
4881 /* If the first value is within an addi range and also the difference
4882 between the two fits in an addi's range, load up the difference, then
4883 conditionally move in 0, and then unconditionally add the first
4884 value. */
4885 else if (IN_RANGE (value1, -2048, 2047)
4886 && IN_RANGE (value2 - value1, -2048, 2047))
4889 /* If neither condition holds, just force the constant into a
4890 register. */
4891 else
4893 src1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src1);
4894 src2 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src2);
4898 /* If one value is a register, insure the other value is either 0 or a
4899 register. */
4900 else
4902 if (GET_CODE (src1) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (src1) != 0)
4903 src1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src1);
4905 if (GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (src2) != 0)
4906 src2 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src2);
4909 test2 = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test, cc_mode, cc_reg, const0_rtx);
4910 if_rtx = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (GET_MODE (dest), test2, src1, src2);
4912 set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, if_rtx);
4914 cr_reg = ((TARGET_ALLOC_CC)
4915 ? gen_reg_rtx (CC_CCRmode)
4916 : gen_rtx_REG (CC_CCRmode,
4917 (cc_mode == CC_FPmode) ? FCR_FIRST : ICR_FIRST));
4919 clobber_cc = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, cr_reg);
4920 emit_insn (gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, gen_rtvec (2, set, clobber_cc)));
4921 return TRUE;
4925 /* Split a conditional move into constituent parts, returning a SEQUENCE
4926 containing all of the insns. */
4929 frv_split_cond_move (rtx operands[])
4931 rtx dest = operands[0];
4932 rtx test = operands[1];
4933 rtx cc_reg = operands[2];
4934 rtx src1 = operands[3];
4935 rtx src2 = operands[4];
4936 rtx cr_reg = operands[5];
4937 rtx ret;
4938 enum machine_mode cr_mode = GET_MODE (cr_reg);
4940 start_sequence ();
4942 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
4943 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
4944 cr_reg,
4945 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (test),
4946 GET_MODE (cr_reg),
4947 cc_reg,
4948 const0_rtx)));
4950 /* Handle various cases of conditional move involving two constants. */
4951 if (GET_CODE (src1) == CONST_INT && GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT)
4953 HOST_WIDE_INT value1 = INTVAL (src1);
4954 HOST_WIDE_INT value2 = INTVAL (src2);
4956 /* Having 0 as one of the constants can be done by loading the other
4957 constant, and optionally moving in gr0. */
4958 if (value1 == 0)
4960 emit_move_insn (dest, src2);
4961 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4962 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg,
4963 const0_rtx),
4964 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
4967 else if (value2 == 0)
4969 emit_move_insn (dest, src1);
4970 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4971 gen_rtx_EQ (cr_mode, cr_reg,
4972 const0_rtx),
4973 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src2)));
4976 /* If the first value is within an addi range and also the difference
4977 between the two fits in an addi's range, load up the difference, then
4978 conditionally move in 0, and then unconditionally add the first
4979 value. */
4980 else if (IN_RANGE (value1, -2048, 2047)
4981 && IN_RANGE (value2 - value1, -2048, 2047))
4983 rtx dest_si = ((GET_MODE (dest) == SImode)
4984 ? dest
4985 : gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, dest, 0));
4987 emit_move_insn (dest_si, GEN_INT (value2 - value1));
4988 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4989 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg,
4990 const0_rtx),
4991 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest_si,
4992 const0_rtx)));
4993 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (dest_si, dest_si, src1));
4996 else
4997 gcc_unreachable ();
4999 else
5001 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being true if needed. */
5002 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src1))
5003 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5004 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5005 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
5007 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being false if needed. */
5008 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src2))
5009 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5010 gen_rtx_EQ (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5011 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src2)));
5014 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
5015 ret = get_insns ();
5016 end_sequence ();
5017 return ret;
5021 /* Split (set DEST SOURCE), where DEST is a double register and SOURCE is a
5022 memory location that is not known to be dword-aligned. */
5023 void
5024 frv_split_double_load (rtx dest, rtx source)
5026 int regno = REGNO (dest);
5027 rtx dest1 = gen_highpart (SImode, dest);
5028 rtx dest2 = gen_lowpart (SImode, dest);
5029 rtx address = XEXP (source, 0);
5031 /* If the address is pre-modified, load the lower-numbered register
5032 first, then load the other register using an integer offset from
5033 the modified base register. This order should always be safe,
5034 since the pre-modification cannot affect the same registers as the
5035 load does.
5037 The situation for other loads is more complicated. Loading one
5038 of the registers could affect the value of ADDRESS, so we must
5039 be careful which order we do them in. */
5040 if (GET_CODE (address) == PRE_MODIFY
5041 || ! refers_to_regno_p (regno, regno + 1, address, NULL))
5043 /* It is safe to load the lower-numbered register first. */
5044 emit_move_insn (dest1, change_address (source, SImode, NULL));
5045 emit_move_insn (dest2, frv_index_memory (source, SImode, 1));
5047 else
5049 /* ADDRESS is not pre-modified and the address depends on the
5050 lower-numbered register. Load the higher-numbered register
5051 first. */
5052 emit_move_insn (dest2, frv_index_memory (source, SImode, 1));
5053 emit_move_insn (dest1, change_address (source, SImode, NULL));
5057 /* Split (set DEST SOURCE), where DEST refers to a dword memory location
5058 and SOURCE is either a double register or the constant zero. */
5059 void
5060 frv_split_double_store (rtx dest, rtx source)
5062 rtx dest1 = change_address (dest, SImode, NULL);
5063 rtx dest2 = frv_index_memory (dest, SImode, 1);
5064 if (ZERO_P (source))
5066 emit_move_insn (dest1, CONST0_RTX (SImode));
5067 emit_move_insn (dest2, CONST0_RTX (SImode));
5069 else
5071 emit_move_insn (dest1, gen_highpart (SImode, source));
5072 emit_move_insn (dest2, gen_lowpart (SImode, source));
5077 /* Split a min/max operation returning a SEQUENCE containing all of the
5078 insns. */
5081 frv_split_minmax (rtx operands[])
5083 rtx dest = operands[0];
5084 rtx minmax = operands[1];
5085 rtx src1 = operands[2];
5086 rtx src2 = operands[3];
5087 rtx cc_reg = operands[4];
5088 rtx cr_reg = operands[5];
5089 rtx ret;
5090 enum rtx_code test_code;
5091 enum machine_mode cr_mode = GET_MODE (cr_reg);
5093 start_sequence ();
5095 /* Figure out which test to use. */
5096 switch (GET_CODE (minmax))
5098 default:
5099 gcc_unreachable ();
5101 case SMIN: test_code = LT; break;
5102 case SMAX: test_code = GT; break;
5103 case UMIN: test_code = LTU; break;
5104 case UMAX: test_code = GTU; break;
5107 /* Issue the compare instruction. */
5108 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5109 cc_reg,
5110 gen_rtx_COMPARE (GET_MODE (cc_reg),
5111 src1, src2)));
5113 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
5114 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5115 cr_reg,
5116 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test_code,
5117 GET_MODE (cr_reg),
5118 cc_reg,
5119 const0_rtx)));
5121 /* If are taking the min/max of a nonzero constant, load that first, and
5122 then do a conditional move of the other value. */
5123 if (GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (src2) != 0)
5125 gcc_assert (!rtx_equal_p (dest, src1));
5127 emit_move_insn (dest, src2);
5128 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5129 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5130 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
5133 /* Otherwise, do each half of the move. */
5134 else
5136 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being true if needed. */
5137 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src1))
5138 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5139 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5140 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
5142 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being false if needed. */
5143 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src2))
5144 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5145 gen_rtx_EQ (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5146 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src2)));
5149 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
5150 ret = get_insns ();
5151 end_sequence ();
5152 return ret;
5156 /* Split an integer abs operation returning a SEQUENCE containing all of the
5157 insns. */
5160 frv_split_abs (rtx operands[])
5162 rtx dest = operands[0];
5163 rtx src = operands[1];
5164 rtx cc_reg = operands[2];
5165 rtx cr_reg = operands[3];
5166 rtx ret;
5168 start_sequence ();
5170 /* Issue the compare < 0 instruction. */
5171 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5172 cc_reg,
5173 gen_rtx_COMPARE (CCmode, src, const0_rtx)));
5175 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
5176 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5177 cr_reg,
5178 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (LT, CC_CCRmode, cc_reg, const0_rtx)));
5180 /* Emit the conditional negate if the value is negative. */
5181 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5182 gen_rtx_NE (CC_CCRmode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5183 gen_negsi2 (dest, src)));
5185 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being false if needed. */
5186 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src))
5187 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5188 gen_rtx_EQ (CC_CCRmode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5189 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src)));
5191 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
5192 ret = get_insns ();
5193 end_sequence ();
5194 return ret;
5198 /* An internal function called by for_each_rtx to clear in a hard_reg set each
5199 register used in an insn. */
5201 static int
5202 frv_clear_registers_used (rtx *ptr, void *data)
5204 if (GET_CODE (*ptr) == REG)
5206 int regno = REGNO (*ptr);
5207 HARD_REG_SET *p_regs = (HARD_REG_SET *)data;
5209 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5211 int reg_max = regno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (*ptr));
5213 while (regno < reg_max)
5215 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*p_regs, regno);
5216 regno++;
5221 return 0;
5225 /* Initialize machine-specific if-conversion data.
5226 On the FR-V, we don't have any extra fields per se, but it is useful hook to
5227 initialize the static storage. */
5228 void
5229 frv_ifcvt_machdep_init (void *ce_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5231 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
5232 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
5233 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec = 0;
5234 frv_ifcvt.cr_reg = NULL_RTX;
5235 frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg = NULL_RTX;
5236 frv_ifcvt.extra_int_cr = NULL_RTX;
5237 frv_ifcvt.extra_fp_cr = NULL_RTX;
5238 frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr = NULL_RTX;
5242 /* Internal function to add a potential insn to the list of insns to be inserted
5243 if the conditional execution conversion is successful. */
5245 static void
5246 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (rtx pattern, rtx insn, int before_p)
5248 rtx link = alloc_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, pattern, insn);
5250 link->jump = before_p; /* Mark to add this before or after insn. */
5251 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = alloc_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, link,
5252 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list);
5254 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5256 fprintf (stderr,
5257 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_add_insn: add the following %s insn %d:\n",
5258 (before_p) ? "before" : "after",
5259 (int)INSN_UID (insn));
5261 debug_rtx (pattern);
5266 /* A C expression to modify the code described by the conditional if
5267 information CE_INFO, possibly updating the tests in TRUE_EXPR, and
5268 FALSE_EXPR for converting if-then and if-then-else code to conditional
5269 instructions. Set either TRUE_EXPR or FALSE_EXPR to a null pointer if the
5270 tests cannot be converted. */
5272 void
5273 frv_ifcvt_modify_tests (ce_if_block_t *ce_info, rtx *p_true, rtx *p_false)
5275 basic_block test_bb = ce_info->test_bb; /* test basic block */
5276 basic_block then_bb = ce_info->then_bb; /* THEN */
5277 basic_block else_bb = ce_info->else_bb; /* ELSE or NULL */
5278 basic_block join_bb = ce_info->join_bb; /* join block or NULL */
5279 rtx true_expr = *p_true;
5280 rtx cr;
5281 rtx cc;
5282 rtx nested_cc;
5283 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (true_expr);
5284 int j;
5285 basic_block *bb;
5286 int num_bb;
5287 frv_tmp_reg_t *tmp_reg = &frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg;
5288 rtx check_insn;
5289 rtx sub_cond_exec_reg;
5290 enum rtx_code code;
5291 enum rtx_code code_true;
5292 enum rtx_code code_false;
5293 enum reg_class cc_class;
5294 enum reg_class cr_class;
5295 int cc_first;
5296 int cc_last;
5297 reg_set_iterator rsi;
5299 /* Make sure we are only dealing with hard registers. Also honor the
5300 -mno-cond-exec switch, and -mno-nested-cond-exec switches if
5301 applicable. */
5302 if (!reload_completed || !TARGET_COND_EXEC
5303 || (!TARGET_NESTED_CE && ce_info->pass > 1))
5304 goto fail;
5306 /* Figure out which registers we can allocate for our own purposes. Only
5307 consider registers that are not preserved across function calls and are
5308 not fixed. However, allow the ICC/ICR temporary registers to be allocated
5309 if we did not need to use them in reloading other registers. */
5310 memset (&tmp_reg->regs, 0, sizeof (tmp_reg->regs));
5311 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (tmp_reg->regs, call_used_reg_set);
5312 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (tmp_reg->regs, fixed_reg_set);
5313 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, ICC_TEMP);
5314 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, ICR_TEMP);
5316 /* If this is a nested IF, we need to discover whether the CC registers that
5317 are set/used inside of the block are used anywhere else. If not, we can
5318 change them to be the CC register that is paired with the CR register that
5319 controls the outermost IF block. */
5320 if (ce_info->pass > 1)
5322 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite);
5323 for (j = CC_FIRST; j <= CC_LAST; j++)
5324 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5326 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (then_bb), j))
5327 continue;
5329 if (else_bb
5330 && REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (else_bb), j))
5331 continue;
5333 if (join_bb
5334 && REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (join_bb), j))
5335 continue;
5337 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite, j);
5341 for (j = 0; j < frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs; j++)
5342 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[j] = NULL_RTX;
5344 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
5345 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
5347 bb = (basic_block *) alloca ((2 + ce_info->num_multiple_test_blocks)
5348 * sizeof (basic_block));
5350 if (join_bb)
5352 unsigned int regno;
5354 /* Remove anything live at the beginning of the join block from being
5355 available for allocation. */
5356 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (df_get_live_in (join_bb), 0, regno, rsi)
5358 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5359 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, regno);
5363 /* Add in all of the blocks in multiple &&/|| blocks to be scanned. */
5364 num_bb = 0;
5365 if (ce_info->num_multiple_test_blocks)
5367 basic_block multiple_test_bb = ce_info->last_test_bb;
5369 while (multiple_test_bb != test_bb)
5371 bb[num_bb++] = multiple_test_bb;
5372 multiple_test_bb = EDGE_PRED (multiple_test_bb, 0)->src;
5376 /* Add in the THEN and ELSE blocks to be scanned. */
5377 bb[num_bb++] = then_bb;
5378 if (else_bb)
5379 bb[num_bb++] = else_bb;
5381 sub_cond_exec_reg = NULL_RTX;
5382 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec = 0;
5384 /* Scan all of the blocks for registers that must not be allocated. */
5385 for (j = 0; j < num_bb; j++)
5387 rtx last_insn = BB_END (bb[j]);
5388 rtx insn = BB_HEAD (bb[j]);
5389 unsigned int regno;
5391 if (dump_file)
5392 fprintf (dump_file, "Scanning %s block %d, start %d, end %d\n",
5393 (bb[j] == else_bb) ? "else" : ((bb[j] == then_bb) ? "then" : "test"),
5394 (int) bb[j]->index,
5395 (int) INSN_UID (BB_HEAD (bb[j])),
5396 (int) INSN_UID (BB_END (bb[j])));
5398 /* Anything live at the beginning of the block is obviously unavailable
5399 for allocation. */
5400 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (df_get_live_in (bb[j]), 0, regno, rsi)
5402 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5403 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, regno);
5406 /* Loop through the insns in the block. */
5407 for (;;)
5409 /* Mark any new registers that are created as being unavailable for
5410 allocation. Also see if the CC register used in nested IFs can be
5411 reallocated. */
5412 if (INSN_P (insn))
5414 rtx pattern;
5415 rtx set;
5416 int skip_nested_if = FALSE;
5418 for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), frv_clear_registers_used,
5419 (void *)&tmp_reg->regs);
5421 pattern = PATTERN (insn);
5422 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == COND_EXEC)
5424 rtx reg = XEXP (COND_EXEC_TEST (pattern), 0);
5426 if (reg != sub_cond_exec_reg)
5428 sub_cond_exec_reg = reg;
5429 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec++;
5433 set = single_set_pattern (pattern);
5434 if (set)
5436 rtx dest = SET_DEST (set);
5437 rtx src = SET_SRC (set);
5439 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
5441 int regno = REGNO (dest);
5442 enum rtx_code src_code = GET_CODE (src);
5444 if (CC_P (regno) && src_code == COMPARE)
5445 skip_nested_if = TRUE;
5447 else if (CR_P (regno)
5448 && (src_code == IF_THEN_ELSE
5449 || COMPARISON_P (src)))
5450 skip_nested_if = TRUE;
5454 if (! skip_nested_if)
5455 for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), frv_clear_registers_used,
5456 (void *)&frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite);
5459 if (insn == last_insn)
5460 break;
5462 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
5466 /* If this is a nested if, rewrite the CC registers that are available to
5467 include the ones that can be rewritten, to increase the chance of being
5468 able to allocate a paired CC/CR register combination. */
5469 if (ce_info->pass > 1)
5471 for (j = CC_FIRST; j <= CC_LAST; j++)
5472 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite, j))
5473 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j);
5474 else
5475 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j);
5478 if (dump_file)
5480 int num_gprs = 0;
5481 fprintf (dump_file, "Available GPRs: ");
5483 for (j = GPR_FIRST; j <= GPR_LAST; j++)
5484 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5486 fprintf (dump_file, " %d [%s]", j, reg_names[j]);
5487 if (++num_gprs > GPR_TEMP_NUM+2)
5488 break;
5491 fprintf (dump_file, "%s\nAvailable CRs: ",
5492 (num_gprs > GPR_TEMP_NUM+2) ? " ..." : "");
5494 for (j = CR_FIRST; j <= CR_LAST; j++)
5495 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5496 fprintf (dump_file, " %d [%s]", j, reg_names[j]);
5498 fputs ("\n", dump_file);
5500 if (ce_info->pass > 1)
5502 fprintf (dump_file, "Modifiable CCs: ");
5503 for (j = CC_FIRST; j <= CC_LAST; j++)
5504 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5505 fprintf (dump_file, " %d [%s]", j, reg_names[j]);
5507 fprintf (dump_file, "\n%d nested COND_EXEC statements\n",
5508 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec);
5512 /* Allocate the appropriate temporary condition code register. Try to
5513 allocate the ICR/FCR register that corresponds to the ICC/FCC register so
5514 that conditional cmp's can be done. */
5515 if (mode == CCmode || mode == CC_UNSmode || mode == CC_NZmode)
5517 cr_class = ICR_REGS;
5518 cc_class = ICC_REGS;
5519 cc_first = ICC_FIRST;
5520 cc_last = ICC_LAST;
5522 else if (mode == CC_FPmode)
5524 cr_class = FCR_REGS;
5525 cc_class = FCC_REGS;
5526 cc_first = FCC_FIRST;
5527 cc_last = FCC_LAST;
5529 else
5531 cc_first = cc_last = 0;
5532 cr_class = cc_class = NO_REGS;
5535 cc = XEXP (true_expr, 0);
5536 nested_cc = cr = NULL_RTX;
5537 if (cc_class != NO_REGS)
5539 /* For nested IFs and &&/||, see if we can find a CC and CR register pair
5540 so we can execute a csubcc/caddcc/cfcmps instruction. */
5541 int cc_regno;
5543 for (cc_regno = cc_first; cc_regno <= cc_last; cc_regno++)
5545 int cr_regno = cc_regno - CC_FIRST + CR_FIRST;
5547 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.regs, cc_regno)
5548 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.regs, cr_regno))
5550 frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.next_reg[ (int)cr_class ] = cr_regno;
5551 cr = frv_alloc_temp_reg (tmp_reg, cr_class, CC_CCRmode, TRUE,
5552 TRUE);
5554 frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.next_reg[ (int)cc_class ] = cc_regno;
5555 nested_cc = frv_alloc_temp_reg (tmp_reg, cc_class, CCmode,
5556 TRUE, TRUE);
5557 break;
5562 if (! cr)
5564 if (dump_file)
5565 fprintf (dump_file, "Could not allocate a CR temporary register\n");
5567 goto fail;
5570 if (dump_file)
5571 fprintf (dump_file,
5572 "Will use %s for conditional execution, %s for nested comparisons\n",
5573 reg_names[ REGNO (cr)],
5574 (nested_cc) ? reg_names[ REGNO (nested_cc) ] : "<none>");
5576 /* Set the CCR bit. Note for integer tests, we reverse the condition so that
5577 in an IF-THEN-ELSE sequence, we are testing the TRUE case against the CCR
5578 bit being true. We don't do this for floating point, because of NaNs. */
5579 code = GET_CODE (true_expr);
5580 if (GET_MODE (cc) != CC_FPmode)
5582 code = reverse_condition (code);
5583 code_true = EQ;
5584 code_false = NE;
5586 else
5588 code_true = NE;
5589 code_false = EQ;
5592 check_insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, cr,
5593 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, CC_CCRmode, cc, const0_rtx));
5595 /* Record the check insn to be inserted later. */
5596 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (check_insn, BB_END (test_bb), TRUE);
5598 /* Update the tests. */
5599 frv_ifcvt.cr_reg = cr;
5600 frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg = nested_cc;
5601 *p_true = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code_true, CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5602 *p_false = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code_false, CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5603 return;
5605 /* Fail, don't do this conditional execution. */
5606 fail:
5607 *p_true = NULL_RTX;
5608 *p_false = NULL_RTX;
5609 if (dump_file)
5610 fprintf (dump_file, "Disabling this conditional execution.\n");
5612 return;
5616 /* A C expression to modify the code described by the conditional if
5617 information CE_INFO, for the basic block BB, possibly updating the tests in
5618 TRUE_EXPR, and FALSE_EXPR for converting the && and || parts of if-then or
5619 if-then-else code to conditional instructions. Set either TRUE_EXPR or
5620 FALSE_EXPR to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted. */
5622 /* p_true and p_false are given expressions of the form:
5624 (and (eq:CC_CCR (reg:CC_CCR)
5625 (const_int 0))
5626 (eq:CC (reg:CC)
5627 (const_int 0))) */
5629 void
5630 frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests (ce_if_block_t *ce_info,
5631 basic_block bb,
5632 rtx *p_true,
5633 rtx *p_false)
5635 rtx old_true = XEXP (*p_true, 0);
5636 rtx old_false = XEXP (*p_false, 0);
5637 rtx true_expr = XEXP (*p_true, 1);
5638 rtx false_expr = XEXP (*p_false, 1);
5639 rtx test_expr;
5640 rtx old_test;
5641 rtx cr = XEXP (old_true, 0);
5642 rtx check_insn;
5643 rtx new_cr = NULL_RTX;
5644 rtx *p_new_cr = (rtx *)0;
5645 rtx if_else;
5646 rtx compare;
5647 rtx cc;
5648 enum reg_class cr_class;
5649 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (true_expr);
5650 rtx (*logical_func)(rtx, rtx, rtx);
5652 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5654 fprintf (stderr,
5655 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests, before modification for %s\ntrue insn:\n",
5656 ce_info->and_and_p ? "&&" : "||");
5658 debug_rtx (*p_true);
5660 fputs ("\nfalse insn:\n", stderr);
5661 debug_rtx (*p_false);
5664 if (!TARGET_MULTI_CE)
5665 goto fail;
5667 if (GET_CODE (cr) != REG)
5668 goto fail;
5670 if (mode == CCmode || mode == CC_UNSmode || mode == CC_NZmode)
5672 cr_class = ICR_REGS;
5673 p_new_cr = &frv_ifcvt.extra_int_cr;
5675 else if (mode == CC_FPmode)
5677 cr_class = FCR_REGS;
5678 p_new_cr = &frv_ifcvt.extra_fp_cr;
5680 else
5681 goto fail;
5683 /* Allocate a temp CR, reusing a previously allocated temp CR if we have 3 or
5684 more &&/|| tests. */
5685 new_cr = *p_new_cr;
5686 if (! new_cr)
5688 new_cr = *p_new_cr = frv_alloc_temp_reg (&frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg, cr_class,
5689 CC_CCRmode, TRUE, TRUE);
5690 if (! new_cr)
5691 goto fail;
5694 if (ce_info->and_and_p)
5696 old_test = old_false;
5697 test_expr = true_expr;
5698 logical_func = (GET_CODE (old_true) == EQ) ? gen_andcr : gen_andncr;
5699 *p_true = gen_rtx_NE (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5700 *p_false = gen_rtx_EQ (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5702 else
5704 old_test = old_false;
5705 test_expr = false_expr;
5706 logical_func = (GET_CODE (old_false) == EQ) ? gen_orcr : gen_orncr;
5707 *p_true = gen_rtx_EQ (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5708 *p_false = gen_rtx_NE (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5711 /* First add the andcr/andncr/orcr/orncr, which will be added after the
5712 conditional check instruction, due to frv_ifcvt_add_insn being a LIFO
5713 stack. */
5714 frv_ifcvt_add_insn ((*logical_func) (cr, cr, new_cr), BB_END (bb), TRUE);
5716 /* Now add the conditional check insn. */
5717 cc = XEXP (test_expr, 0);
5718 compare = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (test_expr), CC_CCRmode, cc, const0_rtx);
5719 if_else = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (CC_CCRmode, old_test, compare, const0_rtx);
5721 check_insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, new_cr, if_else);
5723 /* Add the new check insn to the list of check insns that need to be
5724 inserted. */
5725 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (check_insn, BB_END (bb), TRUE);
5727 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5729 fputs ("\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests, after modification\ntrue insn:\n",
5730 stderr);
5732 debug_rtx (*p_true);
5734 fputs ("\nfalse insn:\n", stderr);
5735 debug_rtx (*p_false);
5738 return;
5740 fail:
5741 *p_true = *p_false = NULL_RTX;
5743 /* If we allocated a CR register, release it. */
5744 if (new_cr)
5746 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.regs, REGNO (new_cr));
5747 *p_new_cr = NULL_RTX;
5750 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5751 fputs ("\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests, failed.\n", stderr);
5753 return;
5757 /* Return a register which will be loaded with a value if an IF block is
5758 converted to conditional execution. This is used to rewrite instructions
5759 that use constants to ones that just use registers. */
5761 static rtx
5762 frv_ifcvt_load_value (rtx value, rtx insn ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5764 int num_alloc = frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs;
5765 int i;
5766 rtx reg;
5768 /* We know gr0 == 0, so replace any errant uses. */
5769 if (value == const0_rtx)
5770 return gen_rtx_REG (SImode, GPR_FIRST);
5772 /* First search all registers currently loaded to see if we have an
5773 applicable constant. */
5774 if (CONSTANT_P (value)
5775 || (GET_CODE (value) == REG && REGNO (value) == LR_REGNO))
5777 for (i = 0; i < num_alloc; i++)
5779 if (rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i]), value))
5780 return SET_DEST (frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i]);
5784 /* Have we exhausted the number of registers available? */
5785 if (num_alloc >= GPR_TEMP_NUM)
5787 if (dump_file)
5788 fprintf (dump_file, "Too many temporary registers allocated\n");
5790 return NULL_RTX;
5793 /* Allocate the new register. */
5794 reg = frv_alloc_temp_reg (&frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg, GPR_REGS, SImode, TRUE, TRUE);
5795 if (! reg)
5797 if (dump_file)
5798 fputs ("Could not find a scratch register\n", dump_file);
5800 return NULL_RTX;
5803 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs++;
5804 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[num_alloc] = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, value);
5806 if (dump_file)
5808 if (GET_CODE (value) == CONST_INT)
5809 fprintf (dump_file, "Register %s will hold %ld\n",
5810 reg_names[ REGNO (reg)], (long)INTVAL (value));
5812 else if (GET_CODE (value) == REG && REGNO (value) == LR_REGNO)
5813 fprintf (dump_file, "Register %s will hold LR\n",
5814 reg_names[ REGNO (reg)]);
5816 else
5817 fprintf (dump_file, "Register %s will hold a saved value\n",
5818 reg_names[ REGNO (reg)]);
5821 return reg;
5825 /* Update a MEM used in conditional code that might contain an offset to put
5826 the offset into a scratch register, so that the conditional load/store
5827 operations can be used. This function returns the original pointer if the
5828 MEM is valid to use in conditional code, NULL if we can't load up the offset
5829 into a temporary register, or the new MEM if we were successful. */
5831 static rtx
5832 frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (rtx mem, enum machine_mode mode, rtx insn)
5834 rtx addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
5836 if (!frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (mode, addr, reload_completed, TRUE, FALSE))
5838 if (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS)
5840 rtx addr_op0 = XEXP (addr, 0);
5841 rtx addr_op1 = XEXP (addr, 1);
5843 if (GET_CODE (addr_op0) == REG && CONSTANT_P (addr_op1))
5845 rtx reg = frv_ifcvt_load_value (addr_op1, insn);
5846 if (!reg)
5847 return NULL_RTX;
5849 addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, addr_op0, reg);
5852 else
5853 return NULL_RTX;
5856 else if (CONSTANT_P (addr))
5857 addr = frv_ifcvt_load_value (addr, insn);
5859 else
5860 return NULL_RTX;
5862 if (addr == NULL_RTX)
5863 return NULL_RTX;
5865 else if (XEXP (mem, 0) != addr)
5866 return change_address (mem, mode, addr);
5869 return mem;
5873 /* Given a PATTERN, return a SET expression if this PATTERN has only a single
5874 SET, possibly conditionally executed. It may also have CLOBBERs, USEs. */
5876 static rtx
5877 single_set_pattern (rtx pattern)
5879 rtx set;
5880 int i;
5882 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == COND_EXEC)
5883 pattern = COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern);
5885 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == SET)
5886 return pattern;
5888 else if (GET_CODE (pattern) == PARALLEL)
5890 for (i = 0, set = 0; i < XVECLEN (pattern, 0); i++)
5892 rtx sub = XVECEXP (pattern, 0, i);
5894 switch (GET_CODE (sub))
5896 case USE:
5897 case CLOBBER:
5898 break;
5900 case SET:
5901 if (set)
5902 return 0;
5903 else
5904 set = sub;
5905 break;
5907 default:
5908 return 0;
5911 return set;
5914 return 0;
5918 /* A C expression to modify the code described by the conditional if
5919 information CE_INFO with the new PATTERN in INSN. If PATTERN is a null
5920 pointer after the IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN macro executes, it is assumed that that
5921 insn cannot be converted to be executed conditionally. */
5924 frv_ifcvt_modify_insn (ce_if_block_t *ce_info,
5925 rtx pattern,
5926 rtx insn)
5928 rtx orig_ce_pattern = pattern;
5929 rtx set;
5930 rtx op0;
5931 rtx op1;
5932 rtx test;
5934 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (pattern) == COND_EXEC);
5936 test = COND_EXEC_TEST (pattern);
5937 if (GET_CODE (test) == AND)
5939 rtx cr = frv_ifcvt.cr_reg;
5940 rtx test_reg;
5942 op0 = XEXP (test, 0);
5943 if (! rtx_equal_p (cr, XEXP (op0, 0)))
5944 goto fail;
5946 op1 = XEXP (test, 1);
5947 test_reg = XEXP (op1, 0);
5948 if (GET_CODE (test_reg) != REG)
5949 goto fail;
5951 /* Is this the first nested if block in this sequence? If so, generate
5952 an andcr or andncr. */
5953 if (! frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr)
5955 rtx and_op;
5957 frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr = test_reg;
5958 if (GET_CODE (op0) == NE)
5959 and_op = gen_andcr (test_reg, cr, test_reg);
5960 else
5961 and_op = gen_andncr (test_reg, cr, test_reg);
5963 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (and_op, insn, TRUE);
5966 /* If this isn't the first statement in the nested if sequence, see if we
5967 are dealing with the same register. */
5968 else if (! rtx_equal_p (test_reg, frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr))
5969 goto fail;
5971 COND_EXEC_TEST (pattern) = test = op1;
5974 /* If this isn't a nested if, reset state variables. */
5975 else
5977 frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr = NULL_RTX;
5980 set = single_set_pattern (pattern);
5981 if (set)
5983 rtx dest = SET_DEST (set);
5984 rtx src = SET_SRC (set);
5985 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
5987 /* Check for normal binary operators. */
5988 if (mode == SImode && ARITHMETIC_P (src))
5990 op0 = XEXP (src, 0);
5991 op1 = XEXP (src, 1);
5993 if (integer_register_operand (op0, SImode) && CONSTANT_P (op1))
5995 op1 = frv_ifcvt_load_value (op1, insn);
5996 if (op1)
5997 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern)
5998 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (src),
5999 GET_MODE (src),
6000 op0, op1));
6001 else
6002 goto fail;
6006 /* For multiply by a constant, we need to handle the sign extending
6007 correctly. Add a USE of the value after the multiply to prevent flow
6008 from cratering because only one register out of the two were used. */
6009 else if (mode == DImode && GET_CODE (src) == MULT)
6011 op0 = XEXP (src, 0);
6012 op1 = XEXP (src, 1);
6013 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SIGN_EXTEND && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
6015 op1 = frv_ifcvt_load_value (op1, insn);
6016 if (op1)
6018 op1 = gen_rtx_SIGN_EXTEND (DImode, op1);
6019 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern)
6020 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest,
6021 gen_rtx_MULT (DImode, op0, op1));
6023 else
6024 goto fail;
6027 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (gen_use (dest), insn, FALSE);
6030 /* If we are just loading a constant created for a nested conditional
6031 execution statement, just load the constant without any conditional
6032 execution, since we know that the constant will not interfere with any
6033 other registers. */
6034 else if (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap
6035 && bitmap_bit_p (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap,
6036 INSN_UID (insn))
6037 && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
6038 /* We must not unconditionally set a scratch reg chosen
6039 for a nested if-converted block if its incoming
6040 value from the TEST block (or the result of the THEN
6041 branch) could/should propagate to the JOIN block.
6042 It suffices to test whether the register is live at
6043 the JOIN point: if it's live there, we can infer
6044 that we set it in the former JOIN block of the
6045 nested if-converted block (otherwise it wouldn't
6046 have been available as a scratch register), and it
6047 is either propagated through or set in the other
6048 conditional block. It's probably not worth trying
6049 to catch the latter case, and it could actually
6050 limit scheduling of the combined block quite
6051 severely. */
6052 && ce_info->join_bb
6053 && ! (REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (ce_info->join_bb),
6054 REGNO (SET_DEST (set))))
6055 /* Similarly, we must not unconditionally set a reg
6056 used as scratch in the THEN branch if the same reg
6057 is live in the ELSE branch. */
6058 && (! ce_info->else_bb
6059 || BLOCK_FOR_INSN (insn) == ce_info->else_bb
6060 || ! (REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (ce_info->else_bb),
6061 REGNO (SET_DEST (set))))))
6062 pattern = set;
6064 else if (mode == QImode || mode == HImode || mode == SImode
6065 || mode == SFmode)
6067 int changed_p = FALSE;
6069 /* Check for just loading up a constant */
6070 if (CONSTANT_P (src) && integer_register_operand (dest, mode))
6072 src = frv_ifcvt_load_value (src, insn);
6073 if (!src)
6074 goto fail;
6076 changed_p = TRUE;
6079 /* See if we need to fix up stores */
6080 if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
6082 rtx new_mem = frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (dest, mode, insn);
6084 if (!new_mem)
6085 goto fail;
6087 else if (new_mem != dest)
6089 changed_p = TRUE;
6090 dest = new_mem;
6094 /* See if we need to fix up loads */
6095 if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
6097 rtx new_mem = frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (src, mode, insn);
6099 if (!new_mem)
6100 goto fail;
6102 else if (new_mem != src)
6104 changed_p = TRUE;
6105 src = new_mem;
6109 /* If either src or destination changed, redo SET. */
6110 if (changed_p)
6111 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern) = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src);
6114 /* Rewrite a nested set cccr in terms of IF_THEN_ELSE. Also deal with
6115 rewriting the CC register to be the same as the paired CC/CR register
6116 for nested ifs. */
6117 else if (mode == CC_CCRmode && COMPARISON_P (src))
6119 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (src, 0));
6120 rtx if_else;
6122 if (ce_info->pass > 1
6123 && regno != (int)REGNO (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg)
6124 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite, regno))
6126 src = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (src),
6127 CC_CCRmode,
6128 frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg,
6129 XEXP (src, 1));
6132 if_else = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (CC_CCRmode, test, src, const0_rtx);
6133 pattern = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, if_else);
6136 /* Remap a nested compare instruction to use the paired CC/CR reg. */
6137 else if (ce_info->pass > 1
6138 && GET_CODE (dest) == REG
6139 && CC_P (REGNO (dest))
6140 && REGNO (dest) != REGNO (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg)
6141 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite,
6142 REGNO (dest))
6143 && GET_CODE (src) == COMPARE)
6145 PUT_MODE (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg, GET_MODE (dest));
6146 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern)
6147 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg, copy_rtx (src));
6151 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
6153 rtx orig_pattern = PATTERN (insn);
6155 PATTERN (insn) = pattern;
6156 fprintf (stderr,
6157 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_insn: pass = %d, insn after modification:\n",
6158 ce_info->pass);
6160 debug_rtx (insn);
6161 PATTERN (insn) = orig_pattern;
6164 return pattern;
6166 fail:
6167 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
6169 rtx orig_pattern = PATTERN (insn);
6171 PATTERN (insn) = orig_ce_pattern;
6172 fprintf (stderr,
6173 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_insn: pass = %d, insn could not be modified:\n",
6174 ce_info->pass);
6176 debug_rtx (insn);
6177 PATTERN (insn) = orig_pattern;
6180 return NULL_RTX;
6184 /* A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
6185 converting code to conditional execution in the code described by the
6186 conditional if information CE_INFO. */
6188 void
6189 frv_ifcvt_modify_final (ce_if_block_t *ce_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6191 rtx existing_insn;
6192 rtx check_insn;
6193 rtx p = frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list;
6194 int i;
6196 /* Loop inserting the check insns. The last check insn is the first test,
6197 and is the appropriate place to insert constants. */
6198 gcc_assert (p);
6202 rtx check_and_insert_insns = XEXP (p, 0);
6203 rtx old_p = p;
6205 check_insn = XEXP (check_and_insert_insns, 0);
6206 existing_insn = XEXP (check_and_insert_insns, 1);
6207 p = XEXP (p, 1);
6209 /* The jump bit is used to say that the new insn is to be inserted BEFORE
6210 the existing insn, otherwise it is to be inserted AFTER. */
6211 if (check_and_insert_insns->jump)
6213 emit_insn_before (check_insn, existing_insn);
6214 check_and_insert_insns->jump = 0;
6216 else
6217 emit_insn_after (check_insn, existing_insn);
6219 free_EXPR_LIST_node (check_and_insert_insns);
6220 free_EXPR_LIST_node (old_p);
6222 while (p != NULL_RTX);
6224 /* Load up any constants needed into temp gprs */
6225 for (i = 0; i < frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs; i++)
6227 rtx insn = emit_insn_before (frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i], existing_insn);
6228 if (! frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap)
6229 frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap = BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL);
6230 bitmap_set_bit (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap, INSN_UID (insn));
6231 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i] = NULL_RTX;
6234 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
6235 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
6239 /* A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in converting
6240 code to conditional execution in the code described by the conditional if
6241 information CE_INFO. */
6243 void
6244 frv_ifcvt_modify_cancel (ce_if_block_t *ce_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6246 int i;
6247 rtx p = frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list;
6249 /* Loop freeing up the EXPR_LIST's allocated. */
6250 while (p != NULL_RTX)
6252 rtx check_and_jump = XEXP (p, 0);
6253 rtx old_p = p;
6255 p = XEXP (p, 1);
6256 free_EXPR_LIST_node (check_and_jump);
6257 free_EXPR_LIST_node (old_p);
6260 /* Release any temporary gprs allocated. */
6261 for (i = 0; i < frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs; i++)
6262 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i] = NULL_RTX;
6264 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
6265 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
6266 return;
6269 /* A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
6270 The template is:
6272 setlo #0, <jmp_reg>
6273 setlo #0, <static_chain>
6274 sethi #0, <jmp_reg>
6275 sethi #0, <static_chain>
6276 jmpl @(gr0,<jmp_reg>) */
6279 frv_trampoline_size (void)
6281 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
6282 /* Allocate room for the function descriptor and the lddi
6283 instruction. */
6284 return 8 + 6 * 4;
6285 return 5 /* instructions */ * 4 /* instruction size. */;
6289 /* A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline. ADDR is an
6290 RTX for the address of the trampoline; FNADDR is an RTX for the address of
6291 the nested function; STATIC_CHAIN is an RTX for the static chain value that
6292 should be passed to the function when it is called.
6294 The template is:
6296 setlo #0, <jmp_reg>
6297 setlo #0, <static_chain>
6298 sethi #0, <jmp_reg>
6299 sethi #0, <static_chain>
6300 jmpl @(gr0,<jmp_reg>) */
6302 static void
6303 frv_trampoline_init (rtx m_tramp, tree fndecl, rtx static_chain)
6305 rtx addr = XEXP (m_tramp, 0);
6306 rtx fnaddr = XEXP (DECL_RTL (fndecl), 0);
6307 rtx sc_reg = force_reg (Pmode, static_chain);
6309 emit_library_call (gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (SImode, "__trampoline_setup"),
6310 LCT_NORMAL, VOIDmode, 4,
6311 addr, Pmode,
6312 GEN_INT (frv_trampoline_size ()), SImode,
6313 fnaddr, Pmode,
6314 sc_reg, Pmode);
6318 /* Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or from
6319 memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the `MQ'
6320 register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or from general
6321 registers, but not memory. Some machines allow copying all registers to and
6322 from memory, but require a scratch register for stores to some memory
6323 locations (e.g., those with symbolic address on the RT, and those with
6324 certain symbolic address on the SPARC when compiling PIC). In some cases,
6325 both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
6327 You should define these macros to indicate to the reload phase that it may
6328 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
6329 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying X to a register
6330 RCLASS in MODE requires an intermediate register, you should define
6331 `SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS' to return the largest register class all of
6332 whose registers can be used as intermediate registers or scratch registers.
6334 If copying a register RCLASS in MODE to X requires an intermediate or scratch
6335 register, `SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS' should be defined to return the
6336 largest register class required. If the requirements for input and output
6337 reloads are the same, the macro `SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS' should be used
6338 instead of defining both macros identically.
6340 The values returned by these macros are often `GENERAL_REGS'. Return
6341 `NO_REGS' if no spare register is needed; i.e., if X can be directly copied
6342 to or from a register of RCLASS in MODE without requiring a scratch register.
6343 Do not define this macro if it would always return `NO_REGS'.
6345 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an intermediate
6346 register), you should define patterns for `reload_inM' or `reload_outM', as
6347 required.. These patterns, which will normally be implemented with a
6348 `define_expand', should be similar to the `movM' patterns, except that
6349 operand 2 is the scratch register.
6351 Define constraints for the reload register and scratch register that contain
6352 a single register class. If the original reload register (whose class is
6353 RCLASS) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the value returned by
6354 these macros is used for the class of the scratch register. Otherwise, two
6355 additional reload registers are required. Their classes are obtained from
6356 the constraints in the insn pattern.
6358 X might be a pseudo-register or a `subreg' of a pseudo-register, which could
6359 either be in a hard register or in memory. Use `true_regnum' to find out;
6360 it will return -1 if the pseudo is in memory and the hard register number if
6361 it is in a register.
6363 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
6364 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
6365 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
6366 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform the
6367 copy and the `movM' pattern should use memory as an intermediate storage.
6368 This case often occurs between floating-point and general registers. */
6370 enum reg_class
6371 frv_secondary_reload_class (enum reg_class rclass,
6372 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6373 rtx x)
6375 enum reg_class ret;
6377 switch (rclass)
6379 default:
6380 ret = NO_REGS;
6381 break;
6383 /* Accumulators/Accumulator guard registers need to go through floating
6384 point registers. */
6385 case QUAD_REGS:
6386 case GPR_REGS:
6387 ret = NO_REGS;
6388 if (x && GET_CODE (x) == REG)
6390 int regno = REGNO (x);
6392 if (ACC_P (regno) || ACCG_P (regno))
6393 ret = FPR_REGS;
6395 break;
6397 /* Nonzero constants should be loaded into an FPR through a GPR. */
6398 case QUAD_FPR_REGS:
6399 if (x && CONSTANT_P (x) && !ZERO_P (x))
6400 ret = GPR_REGS;
6401 else
6402 ret = NO_REGS;
6403 break;
6405 /* All of these types need gpr registers. */
6406 case ICC_REGS:
6407 case FCC_REGS:
6408 case CC_REGS:
6409 case ICR_REGS:
6410 case FCR_REGS:
6411 case CR_REGS:
6412 case LCR_REG:
6413 case LR_REG:
6414 ret = GPR_REGS;
6415 break;
6417 /* The accumulators need fpr registers. */
6418 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6419 case ACCG_REGS:
6420 ret = FPR_REGS;
6421 break;
6424 return ret;
6427 /* This hook exists to catch the case where secondary_reload_class() is
6428 called from init_reg_autoinc() in regclass.c - before the reload optabs
6429 have been initialised. */
6431 static reg_class_t
6432 frv_secondary_reload (bool in_p, rtx x, reg_class_t reload_class_i,
6433 enum machine_mode reload_mode,
6434 secondary_reload_info * sri)
6436 enum reg_class rclass = NO_REGS;
6437 enum reg_class reload_class = (enum reg_class) reload_class_i;
6439 if (sri->prev_sri && sri->prev_sri->t_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6441 sri->icode = sri->prev_sri->t_icode;
6442 return NO_REGS;
6445 rclass = frv_secondary_reload_class (reload_class, reload_mode, x);
6447 if (rclass != NO_REGS)
6449 enum insn_code icode
6450 = direct_optab_handler (in_p ? reload_in_optab : reload_out_optab,
6451 reload_mode);
6452 if (icode == 0)
6454 /* This happens when then the reload_[in|out]_optabs have
6455 not been initialised. */
6456 sri->t_icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
6457 return rclass;
6461 /* Fall back to the default secondary reload handler. */
6462 return default_secondary_reload (in_p, x, reload_class, reload_mode, sri);
6466 /* Worker function for TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P. */
6468 static bool
6469 frv_class_likely_spilled_p (reg_class_t rclass)
6471 switch (rclass)
6473 default:
6474 break;
6476 case GR8_REGS:
6477 case GR9_REGS:
6478 case GR89_REGS:
6479 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6480 case FDPIC_REGS:
6481 case ICC_REGS:
6482 case FCC_REGS:
6483 case CC_REGS:
6484 case ICR_REGS:
6485 case FCR_REGS:
6486 case CR_REGS:
6487 case LCR_REG:
6488 case LR_REG:
6489 case SPR_REGS:
6490 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6491 case ACCG_REGS:
6492 return true;
6495 return false;
6499 /* An expression for the alignment of a structure field FIELD if the
6500 alignment computed in the usual way is COMPUTED. GCC uses this
6501 value instead of the value in `BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT' or
6502 `BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT', if defined, for structure fields only. */
6504 /* The definition type of the bit field data is either char, short, long or
6505 long long. The maximum bit size is the number of bits of its own type.
6507 The bit field data is assigned to a storage unit that has an adequate size
6508 for bit field data retention and is located at the smallest address.
6510 Consecutive bit field data are packed at consecutive bits having the same
6511 storage unit, with regard to the type, beginning with the MSB and continuing
6512 toward the LSB.
6514 If a field to be assigned lies over a bit field type boundary, its
6515 assignment is completed by aligning it with a boundary suitable for the
6516 type.
6518 When a bit field having a bit length of 0 is declared, it is forcibly
6519 assigned to the next storage unit.
6521 e.g)
6522 struct {
6523 int a:2;
6524 int b:6;
6525 char c:4;
6526 int d:10;
6527 int :0;
6528 int f:2;
6529 } x;
6531 +0 +1 +2 +3
6532 &x 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6533 MLM----L
6535 &x+4 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6536 M--L
6538 &x+8 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6539 M----------L
6541 &x+12 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6547 frv_adjust_field_align (tree field, int computed)
6549 /* Make sure that the bitfield is not wider than the type. */
6550 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
6551 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (field))
6553 tree parent = DECL_CONTEXT (field);
6554 tree prev = NULL_TREE;
6555 tree cur;
6557 for (cur = TYPE_FIELDS (parent); cur && cur != field; cur = DECL_CHAIN (cur))
6559 if (TREE_CODE (cur) != FIELD_DECL)
6560 continue;
6562 prev = cur;
6565 gcc_assert (cur);
6567 /* If this isn't a :0 field and if the previous element is a bitfield
6568 also, see if the type is different, if so, we will need to align the
6569 bit-field to the next boundary. */
6570 if (prev
6571 && ! DECL_PACKED (field)
6572 && ! integer_zerop (DECL_SIZE (field))
6573 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field) != DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (prev))
6575 int prev_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (prev));
6576 int cur_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (field));
6577 computed = (prev_align > cur_align) ? prev_align : cur_align;
6581 return computed;
6585 /* A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value of mode
6586 MODE in hard register number REGNO (or in several registers starting with
6587 that one). For a machine where all registers are equivalent, a suitable
6588 definition is
6590 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
6592 It is not necessary for this macro to check for the numbers of fixed
6593 registers, because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always
6594 occupied.
6596 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd register
6597 pairs. The way to implement that is to define this macro to reject odd
6598 register numbers for such modes.
6600 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
6601 `movMODE' instruction pattern support moves between the register and any
6602 other hard register for which the mode is OK; and that moving a value into
6603 the register and back out not alter it.
6605 Since the same instruction used to move `SImode' will work for all narrower
6606 integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK'
6607 to distinguish between these modes, provided you define patterns `movhi',
6608 etc., to take advantage of this. This is useful because of the interaction
6609 between `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK' and `MODES_TIEABLE_P'; it is very desirable for
6610 all integer modes to be tieable.
6612 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic. Often
6613 people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only in floating
6614 point registers. This is not true. Any registers that can hold integers
6615 can safely *hold* a floating point machine mode, whether or not floating
6616 arithmetic can be done on it in those registers. Integer move instructions
6617 can be used to move the values.
6619 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine modes
6620 may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating registers
6621 normalize any value stored in them, because storing a non-floating value
6622 there would garble it. In this case, `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK' should reject
6623 fixed-point machine modes in floating registers. But if the floating
6624 registers do not automatically normalize, if you can store any bit pattern
6625 in one and retrieve it unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may
6626 go in a floating register, so you can define this macro to say so.
6628 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that they
6629 are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic instructions.
6630 However, this is of no concern to `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK'. You handle it by
6631 writing the proper constraints for those instructions.
6633 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access, so
6634 that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a register
6635 if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the floating
6636 registers are not in class `GENERAL_REGS', they will not be used unless some
6637 pattern's constraint asks for one. */
6640 frv_hard_regno_mode_ok (int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
6642 int base;
6643 int mask;
6645 switch (mode)
6647 case CCmode:
6648 case CC_UNSmode:
6649 case CC_NZmode:
6650 return ICC_P (regno) || GPR_P (regno);
6652 case CC_CCRmode:
6653 return CR_P (regno) || GPR_P (regno);
6655 case CC_FPmode:
6656 return FCC_P (regno) || GPR_P (regno);
6658 default:
6659 break;
6662 /* Set BASE to the first register in REGNO's class. Set MASK to the
6663 bits that must be clear in (REGNO - BASE) for the register to be
6664 well-aligned. */
6665 if (INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode) || FLOAT_MODE_P (mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (mode))
6667 if (ACCG_P (regno))
6669 /* ACCGs store one byte. Two-byte quantities must start in
6670 even-numbered registers, four-byte ones in registers whose
6671 numbers are divisible by four, and so on. */
6672 base = ACCG_FIRST;
6673 mask = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1;
6675 else
6677 /* The other registers store one word. */
6678 if (GPR_P (regno) || regno == AP_FIRST)
6679 base = GPR_FIRST;
6681 else if (FPR_P (regno))
6682 base = FPR_FIRST;
6684 else if (ACC_P (regno))
6685 base = ACC_FIRST;
6687 else if (SPR_P (regno))
6688 return mode == SImode;
6690 /* Fill in the table. */
6691 else
6692 return 0;
6694 /* Anything smaller than an SI is OK in any word-sized register. */
6695 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < 4)
6696 return 1;
6698 mask = (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 4) - 1;
6700 return (((regno - base) & mask) == 0);
6703 return 0;
6707 /* A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting at
6708 register number REGNO, required to hold a value of mode MODE.
6710 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable definition
6711 of this macro is
6713 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
6714 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
6715 / UNITS_PER_WORD)) */
6717 /* On the FRV, make the CC_FP mode take 3 words in the integer registers, so
6718 that we can build the appropriate instructions to properly reload the
6719 values. Also, make the byte-sized accumulator guards use one guard
6720 for each byte. */
6723 frv_hard_regno_nregs (int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
6725 if (ACCG_P (regno))
6726 return GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
6727 else
6728 return (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
6732 /* A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers of
6733 class RCLASS needed to hold a value of mode MODE.
6735 This is closely related to the macro `HARD_REGNO_NREGS'. In fact, the value
6736 of the macro `CLASS_MAX_NREGS (RCLASS, MODE)' should be the maximum value of
6737 `HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO, MODE)' for all REGNO values in the class RCLASS.
6739 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values in
6740 the reload pass.
6742 This declaration is required. */
6745 frv_class_max_nregs (enum reg_class rclass, enum machine_mode mode)
6747 if (rclass == ACCG_REGS)
6748 /* An N-byte value requires N accumulator guards. */
6749 return GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
6750 else
6751 return (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
6755 /* A C expression that is nonzero if X is a legitimate constant for an
6756 immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that X satisfies
6757 `CONSTANT_P', so you need not check this. In fact, `1' is a suitable
6758 definition for this macro on machines where anything `CONSTANT_P' is valid. */
6760 static bool
6761 frv_legitimate_constant_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x)
6763 /* frv_cannot_force_const_mem always returns true for FDPIC. This
6764 means that the move expanders will be expected to deal with most
6765 kinds of constant, regardless of what we return here.
6767 However, among its other duties, frv_legitimate_constant_p decides whether
6768 a constant can be entered into reg_equiv_constant[]. If we return true,
6769 reload can create new instances of the constant whenever it likes.
6771 The idea is therefore to accept as many constants as possible (to give
6772 reload more freedom) while rejecting constants that can only be created
6773 at certain times. In particular, anything with a symbolic component will
6774 require use of the pseudo FDPIC register, which is only available before
6775 reload. */
6776 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
6777 return LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (x);
6779 /* All of the integer constants are ok. */
6780 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_DOUBLE)
6781 return TRUE;
6783 /* double integer constants are ok. */
6784 if (GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode || mode == DImode)
6785 return TRUE;
6787 /* 0 is always ok. */
6788 if (x == CONST0_RTX (mode))
6789 return TRUE;
6791 /* If floating point is just emulated, allow any constant, since it will be
6792 constructed in the GPRs. */
6793 if (!TARGET_HAS_FPRS)
6794 return TRUE;
6796 if (mode == DFmode && !TARGET_DOUBLE)
6797 return TRUE;
6799 /* Otherwise store the constant away and do a load. */
6800 return FALSE;
6803 /* Implement SELECT_CC_MODE. Choose CC_FP for floating-point comparisons,
6804 CC_NZ for comparisons against zero in which a single Z or N flag test
6805 is enough, CC_UNS for other unsigned comparisons, and CC for other
6806 signed comparisons. */
6808 enum machine_mode
6809 frv_select_cc_mode (enum rtx_code code, rtx x, rtx y)
6811 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) == MODE_FLOAT)
6812 return CC_FPmode;
6814 switch (code)
6816 case EQ:
6817 case NE:
6818 case LT:
6819 case GE:
6820 return y == const0_rtx ? CC_NZmode : CCmode;
6822 case GTU:
6823 case GEU:
6824 case LTU:
6825 case LEU:
6826 return y == const0_rtx ? CC_NZmode : CC_UNSmode;
6828 default:
6829 return CCmode;
6834 /* Worker function for TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST. */
6836 #define HIGH_COST 40
6837 #define MEDIUM_COST 3
6838 #define LOW_COST 1
6840 static int
6841 frv_register_move_cost (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6842 reg_class_t from, reg_class_t to)
6844 switch (from)
6846 default:
6847 break;
6849 case QUAD_REGS:
6850 case GPR_REGS:
6851 case GR8_REGS:
6852 case GR9_REGS:
6853 case GR89_REGS:
6854 case FDPIC_REGS:
6855 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6856 case FDPIC_CALL_REGS:
6858 switch (to)
6860 default:
6861 break;
6863 case QUAD_REGS:
6864 case GPR_REGS:
6865 case GR8_REGS:
6866 case GR9_REGS:
6867 case GR89_REGS:
6868 case FDPIC_REGS:
6869 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6870 case FDPIC_CALL_REGS:
6872 return LOW_COST;
6874 case FPR_REGS:
6875 return LOW_COST;
6877 case LCR_REG:
6878 case LR_REG:
6879 case SPR_REGS:
6880 return LOW_COST;
6883 case QUAD_FPR_REGS:
6884 switch (to)
6886 default:
6887 break;
6889 case QUAD_REGS:
6890 case GPR_REGS:
6891 case GR8_REGS:
6892 case GR9_REGS:
6893 case GR89_REGS:
6894 case FDPIC_REGS:
6895 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6896 case FDPIC_CALL_REGS:
6898 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6899 case ACCG_REGS:
6900 return MEDIUM_COST;
6902 case QUAD_FPR_REGS:
6903 return LOW_COST;
6906 case LCR_REG:
6907 case LR_REG:
6908 case SPR_REGS:
6909 switch (to)
6911 default:
6912 break;
6914 case QUAD_REGS:
6915 case GPR_REGS:
6916 case GR8_REGS:
6917 case GR9_REGS:
6918 case GR89_REGS:
6919 case FDPIC_REGS:
6920 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6921 case FDPIC_CALL_REGS:
6923 return MEDIUM_COST;
6926 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6927 case ACCG_REGS:
6928 switch (to)
6930 default:
6931 break;
6933 case QUAD_FPR_REGS:
6934 return MEDIUM_COST;
6939 return HIGH_COST;
6942 /* Worker function for TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST. */
6944 static int
6945 frv_memory_move_cost (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6946 reg_class_t rclass ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6947 bool in ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6949 return 4;
6953 /* Implementation of TARGET_ASM_INTEGER. In the FRV case we need to
6954 use ".picptr" to generate safe relocations for PIC code. We also
6955 need a fixup entry for aligned (non-debugging) code. */
6957 static bool
6958 frv_assemble_integer (rtx value, unsigned int size, int aligned_p)
6960 if ((flag_pic || TARGET_FDPIC) && size == UNITS_PER_WORD)
6962 if (GET_CODE (value) == CONST
6963 || GET_CODE (value) == SYMBOL_REF
6964 || GET_CODE (value) == LABEL_REF)
6966 if (TARGET_FDPIC && GET_CODE (value) == SYMBOL_REF
6967 && SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (value))
6969 fputs ("\t.picptr\tfuncdesc(", asm_out_file);
6970 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, value);
6971 fputs (")\n", asm_out_file);
6972 return true;
6974 else if (TARGET_FDPIC && GET_CODE (value) == CONST
6975 && frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (value))
6976 return false;
6977 if (aligned_p && !TARGET_FDPIC)
6979 static int label_num = 0;
6980 char buf[256];
6981 const char *p;
6983 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, "LCP", label_num++);
6984 p = (* targetm.strip_name_encoding) (buf);
6986 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s:\n", p);
6987 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s\n", FIXUP_SECTION_ASM_OP);
6988 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.picptr\t%s\n", p);
6989 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.previous\n");
6991 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.picptr\t", value);
6992 return true;
6994 if (!aligned_p)
6996 /* We've set the unaligned SI op to NULL, so we always have to
6997 handle the unaligned case here. */
6998 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.4byte\t", value);
6999 return true;
7002 return default_assemble_integer (value, size, aligned_p);
7005 /* Function to set up the backend function structure. */
7007 static struct machine_function *
7008 frv_init_machine_status (void)
7010 return ggc_alloc_cleared_machine_function ();
7013 /* Implement TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE. */
7016 frv_issue_rate (void)
7018 if (!TARGET_PACK)
7019 return 1;
7021 switch (frv_cpu_type)
7023 default:
7024 case FRV_CPU_FR300:
7025 case FRV_CPU_SIMPLE:
7026 return 1;
7028 case FRV_CPU_FR400:
7029 case FRV_CPU_FR405:
7030 case FRV_CPU_FR450:
7031 return 2;
7033 case FRV_CPU_GENERIC:
7034 case FRV_CPU_FR500:
7035 case FRV_CPU_TOMCAT:
7036 return 4;
7038 case FRV_CPU_FR550:
7039 return 8;
7043 /* A for_each_rtx callback. If X refers to an accumulator, return
7044 ACC_GROUP_ODD if the bit 2 of the register number is set and
7045 ACC_GROUP_EVEN if it is clear. Return 0 (ACC_GROUP_NONE)
7046 otherwise. */
7048 static int
7049 frv_acc_group_1 (rtx *x, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7051 if (REG_P (*x))
7053 if (ACC_P (REGNO (*x)))
7054 return (REGNO (*x) - ACC_FIRST) & 4 ? ACC_GROUP_ODD : ACC_GROUP_EVEN;
7055 if (ACCG_P (REGNO (*x)))
7056 return (REGNO (*x) - ACCG_FIRST) & 4 ? ACC_GROUP_ODD : ACC_GROUP_EVEN;
7058 return 0;
7061 /* Return the value of INSN's acc_group attribute. */
7064 frv_acc_group (rtx insn)
7066 /* This distinction only applies to the FR550 packing constraints. */
7067 if (frv_cpu_type != FRV_CPU_FR550)
7068 return ACC_GROUP_NONE;
7069 return for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), frv_acc_group_1, 0);
7072 /* Return the index of the DFA unit in FRV_UNIT_NAMES[] that instruction
7073 INSN will try to claim first. Since this value depends only on the
7074 type attribute, we can cache the results in FRV_TYPE_TO_UNIT[]. */
7076 static unsigned int
7077 frv_insn_unit (rtx insn)
7079 enum attr_type type;
7081 type = get_attr_type (insn);
7082 if (frv_type_to_unit[type] == ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes))
7084 /* We haven't seen this type of instruction before. */
7085 state_t state;
7086 unsigned int unit;
7088 /* Issue the instruction on its own to see which unit it prefers. */
7089 state = alloca (state_size ());
7090 state_reset (state);
7091 state_transition (state, insn);
7093 /* Find out which unit was taken. */
7094 for (unit = 0; unit < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes); unit++)
7095 if (cpu_unit_reservation_p (state, frv_unit_codes[unit]))
7096 break;
7098 gcc_assert (unit != ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes));
7100 frv_type_to_unit[type] = unit;
7102 return frv_type_to_unit[type];
7105 /* Return true if INSN issues to a branch unit. */
7107 static bool
7108 frv_issues_to_branch_unit_p (rtx insn)
7110 return frv_unit_groups[frv_insn_unit (insn)] == GROUP_B;
7113 /* The instructions in the packet, partitioned into groups. */
7114 struct frv_packet_group {
7115 /* How many instructions in the packet belong to this group. */
7116 unsigned int num_insns;
7118 /* A list of the instructions that belong to this group, in the order
7119 they appear in the rtl stream. */
7120 rtx insns[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes)];
7122 /* The contents of INSNS after they have been sorted into the correct
7123 assembly-language order. Element X issues to unit X. The list may
7124 contain extra nops. */
7125 rtx sorted[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes)];
7127 /* The member of frv_nops[] to use in sorted[]. */
7128 rtx nop;
7131 /* The current state of the packing pass, implemented by frv_pack_insns. */
7132 static struct {
7133 /* The state of the pipeline DFA. */
7134 state_t dfa_state;
7136 /* Which hardware registers are set within the current packet,
7137 and the conditions under which they are set. */
7138 regstate_t regstate[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
7140 /* The memory locations that have been modified so far in this
7141 packet. MEM is the memref and COND is the regstate_t condition
7142 under which it is set. */
7143 struct {
7144 rtx mem;
7145 regstate_t cond;
7146 } mems[2];
7148 /* The number of valid entries in MEMS. The value is larger than
7149 ARRAY_SIZE (mems) if there were too many mems to record. */
7150 unsigned int num_mems;
7152 /* The maximum number of instructions that can be packed together. */
7153 unsigned int issue_rate;
7155 /* The instructions in the packet, partitioned into groups. */
7156 struct frv_packet_group groups[NUM_GROUPS];
7158 /* The instructions that make up the current packet. */
7159 rtx insns[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes)];
7160 unsigned int num_insns;
7161 } frv_packet;
7163 /* Return the regstate_t flags for the given COND_EXEC condition.
7164 Abort if the condition isn't in the right form. */
7166 static int
7167 frv_cond_flags (rtx cond)
7169 gcc_assert ((GET_CODE (cond) == EQ || GET_CODE (cond) == NE)
7170 && GET_CODE (XEXP (cond, 0)) == REG
7171 && CR_P (REGNO (XEXP (cond, 0)))
7172 && XEXP (cond, 1) == const0_rtx);
7173 return ((REGNO (XEXP (cond, 0)) - CR_FIRST)
7174 | (GET_CODE (cond) == NE
7175 ? REGSTATE_IF_TRUE
7176 : REGSTATE_IF_FALSE));
7180 /* Return true if something accessed under condition COND2 can
7181 conflict with something written under condition COND1. */
7183 static bool
7184 frv_regstate_conflict_p (regstate_t cond1, regstate_t cond2)
7186 /* If either reference was unconditional, we have a conflict. */
7187 if ((cond1 & REGSTATE_IF_EITHER) == 0
7188 || (cond2 & REGSTATE_IF_EITHER) == 0)
7189 return true;
7191 /* The references might conflict if they were controlled by
7192 different CRs. */
7193 if ((cond1 & REGSTATE_CC_MASK) != (cond2 & REGSTATE_CC_MASK))
7194 return true;
7196 /* They definitely conflict if they are controlled by the
7197 same condition. */
7198 if ((cond1 & cond2 & REGSTATE_IF_EITHER) != 0)
7199 return true;
7201 return false;
7205 /* A for_each_rtx callback. Return 1 if *X depends on an instruction in
7206 the current packet. DATA points to a regstate_t that describes the
7207 condition under which *X might be set or used. */
7209 static int
7210 frv_registers_conflict_p_1 (rtx *x, void *data)
7212 unsigned int regno, i;
7213 regstate_t cond;
7215 cond = *(regstate_t *) data;
7217 if (GET_CODE (*x) == REG)
7218 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, *x)
7219 if ((frv_packet.regstate[regno] & REGSTATE_MODIFIED) != 0)
7220 if (frv_regstate_conflict_p (frv_packet.regstate[regno], cond))
7221 return 1;
7223 if (GET_CODE (*x) == MEM)
7225 /* If we ran out of memory slots, assume a conflict. */
7226 if (frv_packet.num_mems > ARRAY_SIZE (frv_packet.mems))
7227 return 1;
7229 /* Check for output or true dependencies with earlier MEMs. */
7230 for (i = 0; i < frv_packet.num_mems; i++)
7231 if (frv_regstate_conflict_p (frv_packet.mems[i].cond, cond))
7233 if (true_dependence (frv_packet.mems[i].mem, VOIDmode, *x))
7234 return 1;
7236 if (output_dependence (frv_packet.mems[i].mem, *x))
7237 return 1;
7241 /* The return values of calls aren't significant: they describe
7242 the effect of the call as a whole, not of the insn itself. */
7243 if (GET_CODE (*x) == SET && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (*x)) == CALL)
7245 if (for_each_rtx (&SET_SRC (*x), frv_registers_conflict_p_1, data))
7246 return 1;
7247 return -1;
7250 /* Check subexpressions. */
7251 return 0;
7255 /* Return true if something in X might depend on an instruction
7256 in the current packet. */
7258 static bool
7259 frv_registers_conflict_p (rtx x)
7261 regstate_t flags;
7263 flags = 0;
7264 if (GET_CODE (x) == COND_EXEC)
7266 if (for_each_rtx (&XEXP (x, 0), frv_registers_conflict_p_1, &flags))
7267 return true;
7269 flags |= frv_cond_flags (XEXP (x, 0));
7270 x = XEXP (x, 1);
7272 return for_each_rtx (&x, frv_registers_conflict_p_1, &flags);
7276 /* A note_stores callback. DATA points to the regstate_t condition
7277 under which X is modified. Update FRV_PACKET accordingly. */
7279 static void
7280 frv_registers_update_1 (rtx x, const_rtx pat ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data)
7282 unsigned int regno;
7284 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
7285 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, x)
7286 frv_packet.regstate[regno] |= *(regstate_t *) data;
7288 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
7290 if (frv_packet.num_mems < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_packet.mems))
7292 frv_packet.mems[frv_packet.num_mems].mem = x;
7293 frv_packet.mems[frv_packet.num_mems].cond = *(regstate_t *) data;
7295 frv_packet.num_mems++;
7300 /* Update the register state information for an instruction whose
7301 body is X. */
7303 static void
7304 frv_registers_update (rtx x)
7306 regstate_t flags;
7308 flags = REGSTATE_MODIFIED;
7309 if (GET_CODE (x) == COND_EXEC)
7311 flags |= frv_cond_flags (XEXP (x, 0));
7312 x = XEXP (x, 1);
7314 note_stores (x, frv_registers_update_1, &flags);
7318 /* Initialize frv_packet for the start of a new packet. */
7320 static void
7321 frv_start_packet (void)
7323 enum frv_insn_group group;
7325 memset (frv_packet.regstate, 0, sizeof (frv_packet.regstate));
7326 frv_packet.num_mems = 0;
7327 frv_packet.num_insns = 0;
7328 for (group = GROUP_I; group < NUM_GROUPS;
7329 group = (enum frv_insn_group) (group + 1))
7330 frv_packet.groups[group].num_insns = 0;
7334 /* Likewise for the start of a new basic block. */
7336 static void
7337 frv_start_packet_block (void)
7339 state_reset (frv_packet.dfa_state);
7340 frv_start_packet ();
7344 /* Finish the current packet, if any, and start a new one. Call
7345 HANDLE_PACKET with FRV_PACKET describing the completed packet. */
7347 static void
7348 frv_finish_packet (void (*handle_packet) (void))
7350 if (frv_packet.num_insns > 0)
7352 handle_packet ();
7353 state_transition (frv_packet.dfa_state, 0);
7354 frv_start_packet ();
7359 /* Return true if INSN can be added to the current packet. Update
7360 the DFA state on success. */
7362 static bool
7363 frv_pack_insn_p (rtx insn)
7365 /* See if the packet is already as long as it can be. */
7366 if (frv_packet.num_insns == frv_packet.issue_rate)
7367 return false;
7369 /* If the scheduler thought that an instruction should start a packet,
7370 it's usually a good idea to believe it. It knows much more about
7371 the latencies than we do.
7373 There are some exceptions though:
7375 - Conditional instructions are scheduled on the assumption that
7376 they will be executed. This is usually a good thing, since it
7377 tends to avoid unnecessary stalls in the conditional code.
7378 But we want to pack conditional instructions as tightly as
7379 possible, in order to optimize the case where they aren't
7380 executed.
7382 - The scheduler will always put branches on their own, even
7383 if there's no real dependency.
7385 - There's no point putting a call in its own packet unless
7386 we have to. */
7387 if (frv_packet.num_insns > 0
7388 && GET_CODE (insn) == INSN
7389 && GET_MODE (insn) == TImode
7390 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != COND_EXEC)
7391 return false;
7393 /* Check for register conflicts. Don't do this for setlo since any
7394 conflict will be with the partnering sethi, with which it can
7395 be packed. */
7396 if (get_attr_type (insn) != TYPE_SETLO)
7397 if (frv_registers_conflict_p (PATTERN (insn)))
7398 return false;
7400 return state_transition (frv_packet.dfa_state, insn) < 0;
7404 /* Add instruction INSN to the current packet. */
7406 static void
7407 frv_add_insn_to_packet (rtx insn)
7409 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7411 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[frv_unit_groups[frv_insn_unit (insn)]];
7412 packet_group->insns[packet_group->num_insns++] = insn;
7413 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns++] = insn;
7415 frv_registers_update (PATTERN (insn));
7419 /* Insert INSN (a member of frv_nops[]) into the current packet. If the
7420 packet ends in a branch or call, insert the nop before it, otherwise
7421 add to the end. */
7423 static void
7424 frv_insert_nop_in_packet (rtx insn)
7426 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7427 rtx last;
7429 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[frv_unit_groups[frv_insn_unit (insn)]];
7430 last = frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1];
7431 if (GET_CODE (last) != INSN)
7433 insn = emit_insn_before (PATTERN (insn), last);
7434 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1] = insn;
7435 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns++] = last;
7437 else
7439 insn = emit_insn_after (PATTERN (insn), last);
7440 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns++] = insn;
7442 packet_group->insns[packet_group->num_insns++] = insn;
7446 /* If packing is enabled, divide the instructions into packets and
7447 return true. Call HANDLE_PACKET for each complete packet. */
7449 static bool
7450 frv_for_each_packet (void (*handle_packet) (void))
7452 rtx insn, next_insn;
7454 frv_packet.issue_rate = frv_issue_rate ();
7456 /* Early exit if we don't want to pack insns. */
7457 if (!optimize
7458 || !flag_schedule_insns_after_reload
7459 || !TARGET_VLIW_BRANCH
7460 || frv_packet.issue_rate == 1)
7461 return false;
7463 /* Set up the initial packing state. */
7464 dfa_start ();
7465 frv_packet.dfa_state = alloca (state_size ());
7467 frv_start_packet_block ();
7468 for (insn = get_insns (); insn != 0; insn = next_insn)
7470 enum rtx_code code;
7471 bool eh_insn_p;
7473 code = GET_CODE (insn);
7474 next_insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
7476 if (code == CODE_LABEL)
7478 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7479 frv_start_packet_block ();
7482 if (INSN_P (insn))
7483 switch (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)))
7485 case USE:
7486 case CLOBBER:
7487 case ADDR_VEC:
7488 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
7489 break;
7491 default:
7492 /* Calls mustn't be packed on a TOMCAT. */
7493 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN && frv_cpu_type == FRV_CPU_TOMCAT)
7494 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7496 /* Since the last instruction in a packet determines the EH
7497 region, any exception-throwing instruction must come at
7498 the end of reordered packet. Insns that issue to a
7499 branch unit are bound to come last; for others it's
7500 too hard to predict. */
7501 eh_insn_p = (find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL) != NULL);
7502 if (eh_insn_p && !frv_issues_to_branch_unit_p (insn))
7503 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7505 /* Finish the current packet if we can't add INSN to it.
7506 Simulate cycles until INSN is ready to issue. */
7507 if (!frv_pack_insn_p (insn))
7509 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7510 while (!frv_pack_insn_p (insn))
7511 state_transition (frv_packet.dfa_state, 0);
7514 /* Add the instruction to the packet. */
7515 frv_add_insn_to_packet (insn);
7517 /* Calls and jumps end a packet, as do insns that throw
7518 an exception. */
7519 if (code == CALL_INSN || code == JUMP_INSN || eh_insn_p)
7520 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7521 break;
7524 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7525 dfa_finish ();
7526 return true;
7529 /* Subroutine of frv_sort_insn_group. We are trying to sort
7530 frv_packet.groups[GROUP].sorted[0...NUM_INSNS-1] into assembly
7531 language order. We have already picked a new position for
7532 frv_packet.groups[GROUP].sorted[X] if bit X of ISSUED is set.
7533 These instructions will occupy elements [0, LOWER_SLOT) and
7534 [UPPER_SLOT, NUM_INSNS) of the final (sorted) array. STATE is
7535 the DFA state after issuing these instructions.
7537 Try filling elements [LOWER_SLOT, UPPER_SLOT) with every permutation
7538 of the unused instructions. Return true if one such permutation gives
7539 a valid ordering, leaving the successful permutation in sorted[].
7540 Do not modify sorted[] until a valid permutation is found. */
7542 static bool
7543 frv_sort_insn_group_1 (enum frv_insn_group group,
7544 unsigned int lower_slot, unsigned int upper_slot,
7545 unsigned int issued, unsigned int num_insns,
7546 state_t state)
7548 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7549 unsigned int i;
7550 state_t test_state;
7551 size_t dfa_size;
7552 rtx insn;
7554 /* Early success if we've filled all the slots. */
7555 if (lower_slot == upper_slot)
7556 return true;
7558 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7559 dfa_size = state_size ();
7560 test_state = alloca (dfa_size);
7562 /* Try issuing each unused instruction. */
7563 for (i = num_insns - 1; i + 1 != 0; i--)
7564 if (~issued & (1 << i))
7566 insn = packet_group->sorted[i];
7567 memcpy (test_state, state, dfa_size);
7568 if (state_transition (test_state, insn) < 0
7569 && cpu_unit_reservation_p (test_state,
7570 NTH_UNIT (group, upper_slot - 1))
7571 && frv_sort_insn_group_1 (group, lower_slot, upper_slot - 1,
7572 issued | (1 << i), num_insns,
7573 test_state))
7575 packet_group->sorted[upper_slot - 1] = insn;
7576 return true;
7580 return false;
7583 /* Compare two instructions by their frv_insn_unit. */
7585 static int
7586 frv_compare_insns (const void *first, const void *second)
7588 const rtx *const insn1 = (rtx const *) first,
7589 *const insn2 = (rtx const *) second;
7590 return frv_insn_unit (*insn1) - frv_insn_unit (*insn2);
7593 /* Copy frv_packet.groups[GROUP].insns[] to frv_packet.groups[GROUP].sorted[]
7594 and sort it into assembly language order. See frv.md for a description of
7595 the algorithm. */
7597 static void
7598 frv_sort_insn_group (enum frv_insn_group group)
7600 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7601 unsigned int first, i, nop, max_unit, num_slots;
7602 state_t state, test_state;
7603 size_t dfa_size;
7605 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7607 /* Assume no nop is needed. */
7608 packet_group->nop = 0;
7610 if (packet_group->num_insns == 0)
7611 return;
7613 /* Copy insns[] to sorted[]. */
7614 memcpy (packet_group->sorted, packet_group->insns,
7615 sizeof (rtx) * packet_group->num_insns);
7617 /* Sort sorted[] by the unit that each insn tries to take first. */
7618 if (packet_group->num_insns > 1)
7619 qsort (packet_group->sorted, packet_group->num_insns,
7620 sizeof (rtx), frv_compare_insns);
7622 /* That's always enough for branch and control insns. */
7623 if (group == GROUP_B || group == GROUP_C)
7624 return;
7626 dfa_size = state_size ();
7627 state = alloca (dfa_size);
7628 test_state = alloca (dfa_size);
7630 /* Find the highest FIRST such that sorted[0...FIRST-1] can issue
7631 consecutively and such that the DFA takes unit X when sorted[X]
7632 is added. Set STATE to the new DFA state. */
7633 state_reset (test_state);
7634 for (first = 0; first < packet_group->num_insns; first++)
7636 memcpy (state, test_state, dfa_size);
7637 if (state_transition (test_state, packet_group->sorted[first]) >= 0
7638 || !cpu_unit_reservation_p (test_state, NTH_UNIT (group, first)))
7639 break;
7642 /* If all the instructions issued in ascending order, we're done. */
7643 if (first == packet_group->num_insns)
7644 return;
7646 /* Add nops to the end of sorted[] and try each permutation until
7647 we find one that works. */
7648 for (nop = 0; nop < frv_num_nops; nop++)
7650 max_unit = frv_insn_unit (frv_nops[nop]);
7651 if (frv_unit_groups[max_unit] == group)
7653 packet_group->nop = frv_nops[nop];
7654 num_slots = UNIT_NUMBER (max_unit) + 1;
7655 for (i = packet_group->num_insns; i < num_slots; i++)
7656 packet_group->sorted[i] = frv_nops[nop];
7657 if (frv_sort_insn_group_1 (group, first, num_slots,
7658 (1 << first) - 1, num_slots, state))
7659 return;
7662 gcc_unreachable ();
7665 /* Sort the current packet into assembly-language order. Set packing
7666 flags as appropriate. */
7668 static void
7669 frv_reorder_packet (void)
7671 unsigned int cursor[NUM_GROUPS];
7672 rtx insns[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_groups)];
7673 unsigned int unit, to, from;
7674 enum frv_insn_group group;
7675 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7677 /* First sort each group individually. */
7678 for (group = GROUP_I; group < NUM_GROUPS;
7679 group = (enum frv_insn_group) (group + 1))
7681 cursor[group] = 0;
7682 frv_sort_insn_group (group);
7685 /* Go through the unit template and try add an instruction from
7686 that unit's group. */
7687 to = 0;
7688 for (unit = 0; unit < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_groups); unit++)
7690 group = frv_unit_groups[unit];
7691 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7692 if (cursor[group] < packet_group->num_insns)
7694 /* frv_reorg should have added nops for us. */
7695 gcc_assert (packet_group->sorted[cursor[group]]
7696 != packet_group->nop);
7697 insns[to++] = packet_group->sorted[cursor[group]++];
7701 gcc_assert (to == frv_packet.num_insns);
7703 /* Clear the last instruction's packing flag, thus marking the end of
7704 a packet. Reorder the other instructions relative to it. */
7705 CLEAR_PACKING_FLAG (insns[to - 1]);
7706 for (from = 0; from < to - 1; from++)
7708 remove_insn (insns[from]);
7709 add_insn_before (insns[from], insns[to - 1], NULL);
7710 SET_PACKING_FLAG (insns[from]);
7715 /* Divide instructions into packets. Reorder the contents of each
7716 packet so that they are in the correct assembly-language order.
7718 Since this pass can change the raw meaning of the rtl stream, it must
7719 only be called at the last minute, just before the instructions are
7720 written out. */
7722 static void
7723 frv_pack_insns (void)
7725 if (frv_for_each_packet (frv_reorder_packet))
7726 frv_insn_packing_flag = 0;
7727 else
7728 frv_insn_packing_flag = -1;
7731 /* See whether we need to add nops to group GROUP in order to
7732 make a valid packet. */
7734 static void
7735 frv_fill_unused_units (enum frv_insn_group group)
7737 unsigned int non_nops, nops, i;
7738 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7740 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7742 /* Sort the instructions into assembly-language order.
7743 Use nops to fill slots that are otherwise unused. */
7744 frv_sort_insn_group (group);
7746 /* See how many nops are needed before the final useful instruction. */
7747 i = nops = 0;
7748 for (non_nops = 0; non_nops < packet_group->num_insns; non_nops++)
7749 while (packet_group->sorted[i++] == packet_group->nop)
7750 nops++;
7752 /* Insert that many nops into the instruction stream. */
7753 while (nops-- > 0)
7754 frv_insert_nop_in_packet (packet_group->nop);
7757 /* Return true if accesses IO1 and IO2 refer to the same doubleword. */
7759 static bool
7760 frv_same_doubleword_p (const struct frv_io *io1, const struct frv_io *io2)
7762 if (io1->const_address != 0 && io2->const_address != 0)
7763 return io1->const_address == io2->const_address;
7765 if (io1->var_address != 0 && io2->var_address != 0)
7766 return rtx_equal_p (io1->var_address, io2->var_address);
7768 return false;
7771 /* Return true if operations IO1 and IO2 are guaranteed to complete
7772 in order. */
7774 static bool
7775 frv_io_fixed_order_p (const struct frv_io *io1, const struct frv_io *io2)
7777 /* The order of writes is always preserved. */
7778 if (io1->type == FRV_IO_WRITE && io2->type == FRV_IO_WRITE)
7779 return true;
7781 /* The order of reads isn't preserved. */
7782 if (io1->type != FRV_IO_WRITE && io2->type != FRV_IO_WRITE)
7783 return false;
7785 /* One operation is a write and the other is (or could be) a read.
7786 The order is only guaranteed if the accesses are to the same
7787 doubleword. */
7788 return frv_same_doubleword_p (io1, io2);
7791 /* Generalize I/O operation X so that it covers both X and Y. */
7793 static void
7794 frv_io_union (struct frv_io *x, const struct frv_io *y)
7796 if (x->type != y->type)
7797 x->type = FRV_IO_UNKNOWN;
7798 if (!frv_same_doubleword_p (x, y))
7800 x->const_address = 0;
7801 x->var_address = 0;
7805 /* Fill IO with information about the load or store associated with
7806 membar instruction INSN. */
7808 static void
7809 frv_extract_membar (struct frv_io *io, rtx insn)
7811 extract_insn (insn);
7812 io->type = (enum frv_io_type) INTVAL (recog_data.operand[2]);
7813 io->const_address = INTVAL (recog_data.operand[1]);
7814 io->var_address = XEXP (recog_data.operand[0], 0);
7817 /* A note_stores callback for which DATA points to an rtx. Nullify *DATA
7818 if X is a register and *DATA depends on X. */
7820 static void
7821 frv_io_check_address (rtx x, const_rtx pat ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data)
7823 rtx *other = (rtx *) data;
7825 if (REG_P (x) && *other != 0 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, *other))
7826 *other = 0;
7829 /* A note_stores callback for which DATA points to a HARD_REG_SET.
7830 Remove every modified register from the set. */
7832 static void
7833 frv_io_handle_set (rtx x, const_rtx pat ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data)
7835 HARD_REG_SET *set = (HARD_REG_SET *) data;
7836 unsigned int regno;
7838 if (REG_P (x))
7839 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, x)
7840 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*set, regno);
7843 /* A for_each_rtx callback for which DATA points to a HARD_REG_SET.
7844 Add every register in *X to the set. */
7846 static int
7847 frv_io_handle_use_1 (rtx *x, void *data)
7849 HARD_REG_SET *set = (HARD_REG_SET *) data;
7850 unsigned int regno;
7852 if (REG_P (*x))
7853 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, *x)
7854 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*set, regno);
7856 return 0;
7859 /* A note_stores callback that applies frv_io_handle_use_1 to an
7860 entire rhs value. */
7862 static void
7863 frv_io_handle_use (rtx *x, void *data)
7865 for_each_rtx (x, frv_io_handle_use_1, data);
7868 /* Go through block BB looking for membars to remove. There are two
7869 cases where intra-block analysis is enough:
7871 - a membar is redundant if it occurs between two consecutive I/O
7872 operations and if those operations are guaranteed to complete
7873 in order.
7875 - a membar for a __builtin_read is redundant if the result is
7876 used before the next I/O operation is issued.
7878 If the last membar in the block could not be removed, and there
7879 are guaranteed to be no I/O operations between that membar and
7880 the end of the block, store the membar in *LAST_MEMBAR, otherwise
7881 store null.
7883 Describe the block's first I/O operation in *NEXT_IO. Describe
7884 an unknown operation if the block doesn't do any I/O. */
7886 static void
7887 frv_optimize_membar_local (basic_block bb, struct frv_io *next_io,
7888 rtx *last_membar)
7890 HARD_REG_SET used_regs;
7891 rtx next_membar, set, insn;
7892 bool next_is_end_p;
7894 /* NEXT_IO is the next I/O operation to be performed after the current
7895 instruction. It starts off as being an unknown operation. */
7896 memset (next_io, 0, sizeof (*next_io));
7898 /* NEXT_IS_END_P is true if NEXT_IO describes the end of the block. */
7899 next_is_end_p = true;
7901 /* If the current instruction is a __builtin_read or __builtin_write,
7902 NEXT_MEMBAR is the membar instruction associated with it. NEXT_MEMBAR
7903 is null if the membar has already been deleted.
7905 Note that the initialization here should only be needed to
7906 suppress warnings. */
7907 next_membar = 0;
7909 /* USED_REGS is the set of registers that are used before the
7910 next I/O instruction. */
7911 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_regs);
7913 for (insn = BB_END (bb); insn != BB_HEAD (bb); insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
7914 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
7916 /* We can't predict what a call will do to volatile memory. */
7917 memset (next_io, 0, sizeof (struct frv_io));
7918 next_is_end_p = false;
7919 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_regs);
7921 else if (INSN_P (insn))
7922 switch (recog_memoized (insn))
7924 case CODE_FOR_optional_membar_qi:
7925 case CODE_FOR_optional_membar_hi:
7926 case CODE_FOR_optional_membar_si:
7927 case CODE_FOR_optional_membar_di:
7928 next_membar = insn;
7929 if (next_is_end_p)
7931 /* Local information isn't enough to decide whether this
7932 membar is needed. Stash it away for later. */
7933 *last_membar = insn;
7934 frv_extract_membar (next_io, insn);
7935 next_is_end_p = false;
7937 else
7939 /* Check whether the I/O operation before INSN could be
7940 reordered with one described by NEXT_IO. If it can't,
7941 INSN will not be needed. */
7942 struct frv_io prev_io;
7944 frv_extract_membar (&prev_io, insn);
7945 if (frv_io_fixed_order_p (&prev_io, next_io))
7947 if (dump_file)
7948 fprintf (dump_file,
7949 ";; [Local] Removing membar %d since order"
7950 " of accesses is guaranteed\n",
7951 INSN_UID (next_membar));
7953 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
7954 delete_insn (next_membar);
7955 next_membar = 0;
7957 *next_io = prev_io;
7959 break;
7961 default:
7962 /* Invalidate NEXT_IO's address if it depends on something that
7963 is clobbered by INSN. */
7964 if (next_io->var_address)
7965 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), frv_io_check_address,
7966 &next_io->var_address);
7968 /* If the next membar is associated with a __builtin_read,
7969 see if INSN reads from that address. If it does, and if
7970 the destination register is used before the next I/O access,
7971 there is no need for the membar. */
7972 set = PATTERN (insn);
7973 if (next_io->type == FRV_IO_READ
7974 && next_io->var_address != 0
7975 && next_membar != 0
7976 && GET_CODE (set) == SET
7977 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG
7978 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_regs, REGNO (SET_DEST (set))))
7980 rtx src;
7982 src = SET_SRC (set);
7983 if (GET_CODE (src) == ZERO_EXTEND)
7984 src = XEXP (src, 0);
7986 if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM
7987 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (src, 0), next_io->var_address))
7989 if (dump_file)
7990 fprintf (dump_file,
7991 ";; [Local] Removing membar %d since the target"
7992 " of %d is used before the I/O operation\n",
7993 INSN_UID (next_membar), INSN_UID (insn));
7995 if (next_membar == *last_membar)
7996 *last_membar = 0;
7998 delete_insn (next_membar);
7999 next_membar = 0;
8003 /* If INSN has volatile references, forget about any registers
8004 that are used after it. Otherwise forget about uses that
8005 are (or might be) defined by INSN. */
8006 if (volatile_refs_p (PATTERN (insn)))
8007 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_regs);
8008 else
8009 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), frv_io_handle_set, &used_regs);
8011 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn), frv_io_handle_use, &used_regs);
8012 break;
8016 /* See if MEMBAR, the last membar instruction in BB, can be removed.
8017 FIRST_IO[X] describes the first operation performed by basic block X. */
8019 static void
8020 frv_optimize_membar_global (basic_block bb, struct frv_io *first_io,
8021 rtx membar)
8023 struct frv_io this_io, next_io;
8024 edge succ;
8025 edge_iterator ei;
8027 /* We need to keep the membar if there is an edge to the exit block. */
8028 FOR_EACH_EDGE (succ, ei, bb->succs)
8029 /* for (succ = bb->succ; succ != 0; succ = succ->succ_next) */
8030 if (succ->dest == EXIT_BLOCK_PTR)
8031 return;
8033 /* Work out the union of all successor blocks. */
8034 ei = ei_start (bb->succs);
8035 ei_cond (ei, &succ);
8036 /* next_io = first_io[bb->succ->dest->index]; */
8037 next_io = first_io[succ->dest->index];
8038 ei = ei_start (bb->succs);
8039 if (ei_cond (ei, &succ))
8041 for (ei_next (&ei); ei_cond (ei, &succ); ei_next (&ei))
8042 /*for (succ = bb->succ->succ_next; succ != 0; succ = succ->succ_next)*/
8043 frv_io_union (&next_io, &first_io[succ->dest->index]);
8045 else
8046 gcc_unreachable ();
8048 frv_extract_membar (&this_io, membar);
8049 if (frv_io_fixed_order_p (&this_io, &next_io))
8051 if (dump_file)
8052 fprintf (dump_file,
8053 ";; [Global] Removing membar %d since order of accesses"
8054 " is guaranteed\n", INSN_UID (membar));
8056 delete_insn (membar);
8060 /* Remove redundant membars from the current function. */
8062 static void
8063 frv_optimize_membar (void)
8065 basic_block bb;
8066 struct frv_io *first_io;
8067 rtx *last_membar;
8069 compute_bb_for_insn ();
8070 first_io = XCNEWVEC (struct frv_io, last_basic_block);
8071 last_membar = XCNEWVEC (rtx, last_basic_block);
8073 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
8074 frv_optimize_membar_local (bb, &first_io[bb->index],
8075 &last_membar[bb->index]);
8077 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
8078 if (last_membar[bb->index] != 0)
8079 frv_optimize_membar_global (bb, first_io, last_membar[bb->index]);
8081 free (first_io);
8082 free (last_membar);
8085 /* Used by frv_reorg to keep track of the current packet's address. */
8086 static unsigned int frv_packet_address;
8088 /* If the current packet falls through to a label, try to pad the packet
8089 with nops in order to fit the label's alignment requirements. */
8091 static void
8092 frv_align_label (void)
8094 unsigned int alignment, target, nop;
8095 rtx x, last, barrier, label;
8097 /* Walk forward to the start of the next packet. Set ALIGNMENT to the
8098 maximum alignment of that packet, LABEL to the last label between
8099 the packets, and BARRIER to the last barrier. */
8100 last = frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1];
8101 label = barrier = 0;
8102 alignment = 4;
8103 for (x = NEXT_INSN (last); x != 0 && !INSN_P (x); x = NEXT_INSN (x))
8105 if (LABEL_P (x))
8107 unsigned int subalign = 1 << label_to_alignment (x);
8108 alignment = MAX (alignment, subalign);
8109 label = x;
8111 if (BARRIER_P (x))
8112 barrier = x;
8115 /* If -malign-labels, and the packet falls through to an unaligned
8116 label, try introducing a nop to align that label to 8 bytes. */
8117 if (TARGET_ALIGN_LABELS
8118 && label != 0
8119 && barrier == 0
8120 && frv_packet.num_insns < frv_packet.issue_rate)
8121 alignment = MAX (alignment, 8);
8123 /* Advance the address to the end of the current packet. */
8124 frv_packet_address += frv_packet.num_insns * 4;
8126 /* Work out the target address, after alignment. */
8127 target = (frv_packet_address + alignment - 1) & -alignment;
8129 /* If the packet falls through to the label, try to find an efficient
8130 padding sequence. */
8131 if (barrier == 0)
8133 /* First try adding nops to the current packet. */
8134 for (nop = 0; nop < frv_num_nops; nop++)
8135 while (frv_packet_address < target && frv_pack_insn_p (frv_nops[nop]))
8137 frv_insert_nop_in_packet (frv_nops[nop]);
8138 frv_packet_address += 4;
8141 /* If we still haven't reached the target, add some new packets that
8142 contain only nops. If there are two types of nop, insert an
8143 alternating sequence of frv_nops[0] and frv_nops[1], which will
8144 lead to packets like:
8146 nop.p
8147 mnop.p/fnop.p
8148 nop.p
8149 mnop/fnop
8151 etc. Just emit frv_nops[0] if that's the only nop we have. */
8152 last = frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1];
8153 nop = 0;
8154 while (frv_packet_address < target)
8156 last = emit_insn_after (PATTERN (frv_nops[nop]), last);
8157 frv_packet_address += 4;
8158 if (frv_num_nops > 1)
8159 nop ^= 1;
8163 frv_packet_address = target;
8166 /* Subroutine of frv_reorg, called after each packet has been constructed
8167 in frv_packet. */
8169 static void
8170 frv_reorg_packet (void)
8172 frv_fill_unused_units (GROUP_I);
8173 frv_fill_unused_units (GROUP_FM);
8174 frv_align_label ();
8177 /* Add an instruction with pattern NOP to frv_nops[]. */
8179 static void
8180 frv_register_nop (rtx nop)
8182 nop = make_insn_raw (nop);
8183 NEXT_INSN (nop) = 0;
8184 PREV_INSN (nop) = 0;
8185 frv_nops[frv_num_nops++] = nop;
8188 /* Implement TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG. Divide the instructions
8189 into packets and check whether we need to insert nops in order to
8190 fulfill the processor's issue requirements. Also, if the user has
8191 requested a certain alignment for a label, try to meet that alignment
8192 by inserting nops in the previous packet. */
8194 static void
8195 frv_reorg (void)
8197 if (optimize > 0 && TARGET_OPTIMIZE_MEMBAR && cfun->machine->has_membar_p)
8198 frv_optimize_membar ();
8200 frv_num_nops = 0;
8201 frv_register_nop (gen_nop ());
8202 if (TARGET_MEDIA)
8203 frv_register_nop (gen_mnop ());
8204 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
8205 frv_register_nop (gen_fnop ());
8207 /* Estimate the length of each branch. Although this may change after
8208 we've inserted nops, it will only do so in big functions. */
8209 shorten_branches (get_insns ());
8211 frv_packet_address = 0;
8212 frv_for_each_packet (frv_reorg_packet);
8215 #define def_builtin(name, type, code) \
8216 add_builtin_function ((name), (type), (code), BUILT_IN_MD, NULL, NULL)
8218 struct builtin_description
8220 enum insn_code icode;
8221 const char *name;
8222 enum frv_builtins code;
8223 enum rtx_code comparison;
8224 unsigned int flag;
8227 /* Media intrinsics that take a single, constant argument. */
8229 static struct builtin_description bdesc_set[] =
8231 { CODE_FOR_mhdsets, "__MHDSETS", FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETS, UNKNOWN, 0 }
8234 /* Media intrinsics that take just one argument. */
8236 static struct builtin_description bdesc_1arg[] =
8238 { CODE_FOR_mnot, "__MNOT", FRV_BUILTIN_MNOT, UNKNOWN, 0 },
8239 { CODE_FOR_munpackh, "__MUNPACKH", FRV_BUILTIN_MUNPACKH, UNKNOWN, 0 },
8240 { CODE_FOR_mbtoh, "__MBTOH", FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOH, UNKNOWN, 0 },
8241 { CODE_FOR_mhtob, "__MHTOB", FRV_BUILTIN_MHTOB, UNKNOWN, 0},
8242 { CODE_FOR_mabshs, "__MABSHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MABSHS, UNKNOWN, 0 },
8243 { CODE_FOR_scutss, "__SCUTSS", FRV_BUILTIN_SCUTSS, UNKNOWN, 0 }
8246 /* Media intrinsics that take two arguments. */
8248 static struct builtin_description bdesc_2arg[] =
8250 { CODE_FOR_mand, "__MAND", FRV_BUILTIN_MAND, UNKNOWN, 0},
8251 { CODE_FOR_mor, "__MOR", FRV_BUILTIN_MOR, UNKNOWN, 0},
8252 { CODE_FOR_mxor, "__MXOR", FRV_BUILTIN_MXOR, UNKNOWN, 0},
8253 { CODE_FOR_maveh, "__MAVEH", FRV_BUILTIN_MAVEH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8254 { CODE_FOR_msaths, "__MSATHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8255 { CODE_FOR_msathu, "__MSATHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8256 { CODE_FOR_maddhss, "__MADDHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8257 { CODE_FOR_maddhus, "__MADDHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHUS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8258 { CODE_FOR_msubhss, "__MSUBHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8259 { CODE_FOR_msubhus, "__MSUBHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHUS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8260 { CODE_FOR_mqaddhss, "__MQADDHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8261 { CODE_FOR_mqaddhus, "__MQADDHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHUS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8262 { CODE_FOR_mqsubhss, "__MQSUBHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8263 { CODE_FOR_mqsubhus, "__MQSUBHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHUS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8264 { CODE_FOR_mpackh, "__MPACKH", FRV_BUILTIN_MPACKH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8265 { CODE_FOR_mcop1, "__Mcop1", FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP1, UNKNOWN, 0},
8266 { CODE_FOR_mcop2, "__Mcop2", FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP2, UNKNOWN, 0},
8267 { CODE_FOR_mwcut, "__MWCUT", FRV_BUILTIN_MWCUT, UNKNOWN, 0},
8268 { CODE_FOR_mqsaths, "__MQSATHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSATHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8269 { CODE_FOR_mqlclrhs, "__MQLCLRHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQLCLRHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8270 { CODE_FOR_mqlmths, "__MQLMTHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQLMTHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8271 { CODE_FOR_smul, "__SMUL", FRV_BUILTIN_SMUL, UNKNOWN, 0},
8272 { CODE_FOR_umul, "__UMUL", FRV_BUILTIN_UMUL, UNKNOWN, 0},
8273 { CODE_FOR_addss, "__ADDSS", FRV_BUILTIN_ADDSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8274 { CODE_FOR_subss, "__SUBSS", FRV_BUILTIN_SUBSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8275 { CODE_FOR_slass, "__SLASS", FRV_BUILTIN_SLASS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8276 { CODE_FOR_scan, "__SCAN", FRV_BUILTIN_SCAN, UNKNOWN, 0}
8279 /* Integer intrinsics that take two arguments and have no return value. */
8281 static struct builtin_description bdesc_int_void2arg[] =
8283 { CODE_FOR_smass, "__SMASS", FRV_BUILTIN_SMASS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8284 { CODE_FOR_smsss, "__SMSSS", FRV_BUILTIN_SMSSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8285 { CODE_FOR_smu, "__SMU", FRV_BUILTIN_SMU, UNKNOWN, 0}
8288 static struct builtin_description bdesc_prefetches[] =
8290 { CODE_FOR_frv_prefetch0, "__data_prefetch0", FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH0, UNKNOWN,
8292 { CODE_FOR_frv_prefetch, "__data_prefetch", FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH, UNKNOWN, 0}
8295 /* Media intrinsics that take two arguments, the first being an ACC number. */
8297 static struct builtin_description bdesc_cut[] =
8299 { CODE_FOR_mcut, "__MCUT", FRV_BUILTIN_MCUT, UNKNOWN, 0},
8300 { CODE_FOR_mcutss, "__MCUTSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MCUTSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8301 { CODE_FOR_mdcutssi, "__MDCUTSSI", FRV_BUILTIN_MDCUTSSI, UNKNOWN, 0}
8304 /* Two-argument media intrinsics with an immediate second argument. */
8306 static struct builtin_description bdesc_2argimm[] =
8308 { CODE_FOR_mrotli, "__MROTLI", FRV_BUILTIN_MROTLI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8309 { CODE_FOR_mrotri, "__MROTRI", FRV_BUILTIN_MROTRI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8310 { CODE_FOR_msllhi, "__MSLLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MSLLHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8311 { CODE_FOR_msrlhi, "__MSRLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MSRLHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8312 { CODE_FOR_msrahi, "__MSRAHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MSRAHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8313 { CODE_FOR_mexpdhw, "__MEXPDHW", FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHW, UNKNOWN, 0},
8314 { CODE_FOR_mexpdhd, "__MEXPDHD", FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHD, UNKNOWN, 0},
8315 { CODE_FOR_mdrotli, "__MDROTLI", FRV_BUILTIN_MDROTLI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8316 { CODE_FOR_mcplhi, "__MCPLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8317 { CODE_FOR_mcpli, "__MCPLI", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8318 { CODE_FOR_mhsetlos, "__MHSETLOS", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8319 { CODE_FOR_mhsetloh, "__MHSETLOH", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8320 { CODE_FOR_mhsethis, "__MHSETHIS", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8321 { CODE_FOR_mhsethih, "__MHSETHIH", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8322 { CODE_FOR_mhdseth, "__MHDSETH", FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8323 { CODE_FOR_mqsllhi, "__MQSLLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSLLHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8324 { CODE_FOR_mqsrahi, "__MQSRAHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSRAHI, UNKNOWN, 0}
8327 /* Media intrinsics that take two arguments and return void, the first argument
8328 being a pointer to 4 words in memory. */
8330 static struct builtin_description bdesc_void2arg[] =
8332 { CODE_FOR_mdunpackh, "__MDUNPACKH", FRV_BUILTIN_MDUNPACKH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8333 { CODE_FOR_mbtohe, "__MBTOHE", FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOHE, UNKNOWN, 0},
8336 /* Media intrinsics that take three arguments, the first being a const_int that
8337 denotes an accumulator, and that return void. */
8339 static struct builtin_description bdesc_void3arg[] =
8341 { CODE_FOR_mcpxrs, "__MCPXRS", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8342 { CODE_FOR_mcpxru, "__MCPXRU", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8343 { CODE_FOR_mcpxis, "__MCPXIS", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8344 { CODE_FOR_mcpxiu, "__MCPXIU", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8345 { CODE_FOR_mmulhs, "__MMULHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8346 { CODE_FOR_mmulhu, "__MMULHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8347 { CODE_FOR_mmulxhs, "__MMULXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8348 { CODE_FOR_mmulxhu, "__MMULXHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8349 { CODE_FOR_mmachs, "__MMACHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8350 { CODE_FOR_mmachu, "__MMACHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8351 { CODE_FOR_mmrdhs, "__MMRDHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8352 { CODE_FOR_mmrdhu, "__MMRDHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8353 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxrs, "__MQCPXRS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8354 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxru, "__MQCPXRU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8355 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxis, "__MQCPXIS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8356 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxiu, "__MQCPXIU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8357 { CODE_FOR_mqmulhs, "__MQMULHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8358 { CODE_FOR_mqmulhu, "__MQMULHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8359 { CODE_FOR_mqmulxhs, "__MQMULXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8360 { CODE_FOR_mqmulxhu, "__MQMULXHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8361 { CODE_FOR_mqmachs, "__MQMACHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8362 { CODE_FOR_mqmachu, "__MQMACHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8363 { CODE_FOR_mqxmachs, "__MQXMACHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8364 { CODE_FOR_mqxmacxhs, "__MQXMACXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACXHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8365 { CODE_FOR_mqmacxhs, "__MQMACXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACXHS, UNKNOWN, 0}
8368 /* Media intrinsics that take two accumulator numbers as argument and
8369 return void. */
8371 static struct builtin_description bdesc_voidacc[] =
8373 { CODE_FOR_maddaccs, "__MADDACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MADDACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8374 { CODE_FOR_msubaccs, "__MSUBACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8375 { CODE_FOR_masaccs, "__MASACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MASACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8376 { CODE_FOR_mdaddaccs, "__MDADDACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MDADDACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8377 { CODE_FOR_mdsubaccs, "__MDSUBACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MDSUBACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8378 { CODE_FOR_mdasaccs, "__MDASACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MDASACCS, UNKNOWN, 0}
8381 /* Intrinsics that load a value and then issue a MEMBAR. The load is
8382 a normal move and the ICODE is for the membar. */
8384 static struct builtin_description bdesc_loads[] =
8386 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_qi, "__builtin_read8",
8387 FRV_BUILTIN_READ8, UNKNOWN, 0},
8388 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_hi, "__builtin_read16",
8389 FRV_BUILTIN_READ16, UNKNOWN, 0},
8390 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_si, "__builtin_read32",
8391 FRV_BUILTIN_READ32, UNKNOWN, 0},
8392 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_di, "__builtin_read64",
8393 FRV_BUILTIN_READ64, UNKNOWN, 0}
8396 /* Likewise stores. */
8398 static struct builtin_description bdesc_stores[] =
8400 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_qi, "__builtin_write8",
8401 FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE8, UNKNOWN, 0},
8402 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_hi, "__builtin_write16",
8403 FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE16, UNKNOWN, 0},
8404 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_si, "__builtin_write32",
8405 FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE32, UNKNOWN, 0},
8406 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_di, "__builtin_write64",
8407 FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE64, UNKNOWN, 0},
8410 /* Initialize media builtins. */
8412 static void
8413 frv_init_builtins (void)
8415 tree accumulator = integer_type_node;
8416 tree integer = integer_type_node;
8417 tree voidt = void_type_node;
8418 tree uhalf = short_unsigned_type_node;
8419 tree sword1 = long_integer_type_node;
8420 tree uword1 = long_unsigned_type_node;
8421 tree sword2 = long_long_integer_type_node;
8422 tree uword2 = long_long_unsigned_type_node;
8423 tree uword4 = build_pointer_type (uword1);
8424 tree vptr = build_pointer_type (build_type_variant (void_type_node, 0, 1));
8425 tree ubyte = unsigned_char_type_node;
8426 tree iacc = integer_type_node;
8428 #define UNARY(RET, T1) \
8429 build_function_type_list (RET, T1, NULL_TREE)
8431 #define BINARY(RET, T1, T2) \
8432 build_function_type_list (RET, T1, T2, NULL_TREE)
8434 #define TRINARY(RET, T1, T2, T3) \
8435 build_function_type_list (RET, T1, T2, T3, NULL_TREE)
8437 #define QUAD(RET, T1, T2, T3, T4) \
8438 build_function_type_list (RET, T1, T2, T3, NULL_TREE)
8440 tree void_ftype_void = build_function_type_list (voidt, NULL_TREE);
8442 tree void_ftype_acc = UNARY (voidt, accumulator);
8443 tree void_ftype_uw4_uw1 = BINARY (voidt, uword4, uword1);
8444 tree void_ftype_uw4_uw2 = BINARY (voidt, uword4, uword2);
8445 tree void_ftype_acc_uw1 = BINARY (voidt, accumulator, uword1);
8446 tree void_ftype_acc_acc = BINARY (voidt, accumulator, accumulator);
8447 tree void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, uword1, uword1);
8448 tree void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, sword1, sword1);
8449 tree void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, uword2, uword2);
8450 tree void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, sword2, sword2);
8452 tree uw1_ftype_uw1 = UNARY (uword1, uword1);
8453 tree uw1_ftype_sw1 = UNARY (uword1, sword1);
8454 tree uw1_ftype_uw2 = UNARY (uword1, uword2);
8455 tree uw1_ftype_acc = UNARY (uword1, accumulator);
8456 tree uw1_ftype_uh_uh = BINARY (uword1, uhalf, uhalf);
8457 tree uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1 = BINARY (uword1, uword1, uword1);
8458 tree uw1_ftype_uw1_int = BINARY (uword1, uword1, integer);
8459 tree uw1_ftype_acc_uw1 = BINARY (uword1, accumulator, uword1);
8460 tree uw1_ftype_acc_sw1 = BINARY (uword1, accumulator, sword1);
8461 tree uw1_ftype_uw2_uw1 = BINARY (uword1, uword2, uword1);
8462 tree uw1_ftype_uw2_int = BINARY (uword1, uword2, integer);
8464 tree sw1_ftype_int = UNARY (sword1, integer);
8465 tree sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1 = BINARY (sword1, sword1, sword1);
8466 tree sw1_ftype_sw1_int = BINARY (sword1, sword1, integer);
8468 tree uw2_ftype_uw1 = UNARY (uword2, uword1);
8469 tree uw2_ftype_uw1_int = BINARY (uword2, uword1, integer);
8470 tree uw2_ftype_uw2_uw2 = BINARY (uword2, uword2, uword2);
8471 tree uw2_ftype_uw2_int = BINARY (uword2, uword2, integer);
8472 tree uw2_ftype_acc_int = BINARY (uword2, accumulator, integer);
8473 tree uw2_ftype_uh_uh_uh_uh = QUAD (uword2, uhalf, uhalf, uhalf, uhalf);
8475 tree sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2 = BINARY (sword2, sword2, sword2);
8476 tree sw2_ftype_sw2_int = BINARY (sword2, sword2, integer);
8477 tree uw2_ftype_uw1_uw1 = BINARY (uword2, uword1, uword1);
8478 tree sw2_ftype_sw1_sw1 = BINARY (sword2, sword1, sword1);
8479 tree void_ftype_sw1_sw1 = BINARY (voidt, sword1, sword1);
8480 tree void_ftype_iacc_sw2 = BINARY (voidt, iacc, sword2);
8481 tree void_ftype_iacc_sw1 = BINARY (voidt, iacc, sword1);
8482 tree sw1_ftype_sw1 = UNARY (sword1, sword1);
8483 tree sw2_ftype_iacc = UNARY (sword2, iacc);
8484 tree sw1_ftype_iacc = UNARY (sword1, iacc);
8485 tree void_ftype_ptr = UNARY (voidt, const_ptr_type_node);
8486 tree uw1_ftype_vptr = UNARY (uword1, vptr);
8487 tree uw2_ftype_vptr = UNARY (uword2, vptr);
8488 tree void_ftype_vptr_ub = BINARY (voidt, vptr, ubyte);
8489 tree void_ftype_vptr_uh = BINARY (voidt, vptr, uhalf);
8490 tree void_ftype_vptr_uw1 = BINARY (voidt, vptr, uword1);
8491 tree void_ftype_vptr_uw2 = BINARY (voidt, vptr, uword2);
8493 def_builtin ("__MAND", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MAND);
8494 def_builtin ("__MOR", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MOR);
8495 def_builtin ("__MXOR", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MXOR);
8496 def_builtin ("__MNOT", uw1_ftype_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MNOT);
8497 def_builtin ("__MROTLI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MROTLI);
8498 def_builtin ("__MROTRI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MROTRI);
8499 def_builtin ("__MWCUT", uw1_ftype_uw2_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MWCUT);
8500 def_builtin ("__MAVEH", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MAVEH);
8501 def_builtin ("__MSLLHI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MSLLHI);
8502 def_builtin ("__MSRLHI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MSRLHI);
8503 def_builtin ("__MSRAHI", sw1_ftype_sw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MSRAHI);
8504 def_builtin ("__MSATHS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHS);
8505 def_builtin ("__MSATHU", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHU);
8506 def_builtin ("__MADDHSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHSS);
8507 def_builtin ("__MADDHUS", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHUS);
8508 def_builtin ("__MSUBHSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHSS);
8509 def_builtin ("__MSUBHUS", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHUS);
8510 def_builtin ("__MMULHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHS);
8511 def_builtin ("__MMULHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHU);
8512 def_builtin ("__MMULXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHS);
8513 def_builtin ("__MMULXHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHU);
8514 def_builtin ("__MMACHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHS);
8515 def_builtin ("__MMACHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHU);
8516 def_builtin ("__MMRDHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHS);
8517 def_builtin ("__MMRDHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHU);
8518 def_builtin ("__MQADDHSS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHSS);
8519 def_builtin ("__MQADDHUS", uw2_ftype_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHUS);
8520 def_builtin ("__MQSUBHSS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHSS);
8521 def_builtin ("__MQSUBHUS", uw2_ftype_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHUS);
8522 def_builtin ("__MQMULHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHS);
8523 def_builtin ("__MQMULHU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHU);
8524 def_builtin ("__MQMULXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHS);
8525 def_builtin ("__MQMULXHU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHU);
8526 def_builtin ("__MQMACHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHS);
8527 def_builtin ("__MQMACHU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHU);
8528 def_builtin ("__MCPXRS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRS);
8529 def_builtin ("__MCPXRU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRU);
8530 def_builtin ("__MCPXIS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIS);
8531 def_builtin ("__MCPXIU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIU);
8532 def_builtin ("__MQCPXRS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRS);
8533 def_builtin ("__MQCPXRU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRU);
8534 def_builtin ("__MQCPXIS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIS);
8535 def_builtin ("__MQCPXIU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIU);
8536 def_builtin ("__MCUT", uw1_ftype_acc_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCUT);
8537 def_builtin ("__MCUTSS", uw1_ftype_acc_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCUTSS);
8538 def_builtin ("__MEXPDHW", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHW);
8539 def_builtin ("__MEXPDHD", uw2_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHD);
8540 def_builtin ("__MPACKH", uw1_ftype_uh_uh, FRV_BUILTIN_MPACKH);
8541 def_builtin ("__MUNPACKH", uw2_ftype_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MUNPACKH);
8542 def_builtin ("__MDPACKH", uw2_ftype_uh_uh_uh_uh, FRV_BUILTIN_MDPACKH);
8543 def_builtin ("__MDUNPACKH", void_ftype_uw4_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MDUNPACKH);
8544 def_builtin ("__MBTOH", uw2_ftype_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOH);
8545 def_builtin ("__MHTOB", uw1_ftype_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MHTOB);
8546 def_builtin ("__MBTOHE", void_ftype_uw4_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOHE);
8547 def_builtin ("__MCLRACC", void_ftype_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACC);
8548 def_builtin ("__MCLRACCA", void_ftype_void, FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACCA);
8549 def_builtin ("__MRDACC", uw1_ftype_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACC);
8550 def_builtin ("__MRDACCG", uw1_ftype_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACCG);
8551 def_builtin ("__MWTACC", void_ftype_acc_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACC);
8552 def_builtin ("__MWTACCG", void_ftype_acc_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACCG);
8553 def_builtin ("__Mcop1", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP1);
8554 def_builtin ("__Mcop2", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP2);
8555 def_builtin ("__MTRAP", void_ftype_void, FRV_BUILTIN_MTRAP);
8556 def_builtin ("__MQXMACHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACHS);
8557 def_builtin ("__MQXMACXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACXHS);
8558 def_builtin ("__MQMACXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACXHS);
8559 def_builtin ("__MADDACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MADDACCS);
8560 def_builtin ("__MSUBACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBACCS);
8561 def_builtin ("__MASACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MASACCS);
8562 def_builtin ("__MDADDACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MDADDACCS);
8563 def_builtin ("__MDSUBACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MDSUBACCS);
8564 def_builtin ("__MDASACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MDASACCS);
8565 def_builtin ("__MABSHS", uw1_ftype_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MABSHS);
8566 def_builtin ("__MDROTLI", uw2_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MDROTLI);
8567 def_builtin ("__MCPLHI", uw1_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLHI);
8568 def_builtin ("__MCPLI", uw1_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLI);
8569 def_builtin ("__MDCUTSSI", uw2_ftype_acc_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MDCUTSSI);
8570 def_builtin ("__MQSATHS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSATHS);
8571 def_builtin ("__MHSETLOS", sw1_ftype_sw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOS);
8572 def_builtin ("__MHSETHIS", sw1_ftype_sw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIS);
8573 def_builtin ("__MHDSETS", sw1_ftype_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETS);
8574 def_builtin ("__MHSETLOH", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOH);
8575 def_builtin ("__MHSETHIH", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIH);
8576 def_builtin ("__MHDSETH", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETH);
8577 def_builtin ("__MQLCLRHS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQLCLRHS);
8578 def_builtin ("__MQLMTHS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQLMTHS);
8579 def_builtin ("__MQSLLHI", uw2_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSLLHI);
8580 def_builtin ("__MQSRAHI", sw2_ftype_sw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSRAHI);
8581 def_builtin ("__SMUL", sw2_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMUL);
8582 def_builtin ("__UMUL", uw2_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_UMUL);
8583 def_builtin ("__SMASS", void_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMASS);
8584 def_builtin ("__SMSSS", void_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMSSS);
8585 def_builtin ("__SMU", void_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMU);
8586 def_builtin ("__ADDSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_ADDSS);
8587 def_builtin ("__SUBSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SUBSS);
8588 def_builtin ("__SLASS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SLASS);
8589 def_builtin ("__SCAN", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SCAN);
8590 def_builtin ("__SCUTSS", sw1_ftype_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SCUTSS);
8591 def_builtin ("__IACCreadll", sw2_ftype_iacc, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadll);
8592 def_builtin ("__IACCreadl", sw1_ftype_iacc, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadl);
8593 def_builtin ("__IACCsetll", void_ftype_iacc_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetll);
8594 def_builtin ("__IACCsetl", void_ftype_iacc_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetl);
8595 def_builtin ("__data_prefetch0", void_ftype_ptr, FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH0);
8596 def_builtin ("__data_prefetch", void_ftype_ptr, FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH);
8597 def_builtin ("__builtin_read8", uw1_ftype_vptr, FRV_BUILTIN_READ8);
8598 def_builtin ("__builtin_read16", uw1_ftype_vptr, FRV_BUILTIN_READ16);
8599 def_builtin ("__builtin_read32", uw1_ftype_vptr, FRV_BUILTIN_READ32);
8600 def_builtin ("__builtin_read64", uw2_ftype_vptr, FRV_BUILTIN_READ64);
8602 def_builtin ("__builtin_write8", void_ftype_vptr_ub, FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE8);
8603 def_builtin ("__builtin_write16", void_ftype_vptr_uh, FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE16);
8604 def_builtin ("__builtin_write32", void_ftype_vptr_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE32);
8605 def_builtin ("__builtin_write64", void_ftype_vptr_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE64);
8607 #undef UNARY
8608 #undef BINARY
8609 #undef TRINARY
8610 #undef QUAD
8613 /* Set the names for various arithmetic operations according to the
8614 FRV ABI. */
8615 static void
8616 frv_init_libfuncs (void)
8618 set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, SImode, "__modi");
8619 set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, SImode, "__umodi");
8621 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, DImode, "__addll");
8622 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, DImode, "__subll");
8623 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, DImode, "__mulll");
8624 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DImode, "__divll");
8625 set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, DImode, "__modll");
8626 set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, DImode, "__umodll");
8627 set_optab_libfunc (and_optab, DImode, "__andll");
8628 set_optab_libfunc (ior_optab, DImode, "__orll");
8629 set_optab_libfunc (xor_optab, DImode, "__xorll");
8630 set_optab_libfunc (one_cmpl_optab, DImode, "__notll");
8632 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, SFmode, "__addf");
8633 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, SFmode, "__subf");
8634 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, SFmode, "__mulf");
8635 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, SFmode, "__divf");
8637 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, DFmode, "__addd");
8638 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, DFmode, "__subd");
8639 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, DFmode, "__muld");
8640 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DFmode, "__divd");
8642 set_conv_libfunc (sext_optab, DFmode, SFmode, "__ftod");
8643 set_conv_libfunc (trunc_optab, SFmode, DFmode, "__dtof");
8645 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, SFmode, "__ftoi");
8646 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, DImode, SFmode, "__ftoll");
8647 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, DFmode, "__dtoi");
8648 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, DImode, DFmode, "__dtoll");
8650 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, SImode, SFmode, "__ftoui");
8651 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, DImode, SFmode, "__ftoull");
8652 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, SImode, DFmode, "__dtoui");
8653 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, DImode, DFmode, "__dtoull");
8655 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, SFmode, SImode, "__itof");
8656 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, SFmode, DImode, "__lltof");
8657 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, DFmode, SImode, "__itod");
8658 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, DFmode, DImode, "__lltod");
8661 /* Convert an integer constant to an accumulator register. ICODE is the
8662 code of the target instruction, OPNUM is the number of the
8663 accumulator operand and OPVAL is the constant integer. Try both
8664 ACC and ACCG registers; only report an error if neither fit the
8665 instruction. */
8667 static rtx
8668 frv_int_to_acc (enum insn_code icode, int opnum, rtx opval)
8670 rtx reg;
8671 int i;
8673 /* ACCs and ACCGs are implicit global registers if media intrinsics
8674 are being used. We set up this lazily to avoid creating lots of
8675 unnecessary call_insn rtl in non-media code. */
8676 for (i = 0; i <= ACC_MASK; i++)
8677 if ((i & ACC_MASK) == i)
8678 global_regs[i + ACC_FIRST] = global_regs[i + ACCG_FIRST] = 1;
8680 if (GET_CODE (opval) != CONST_INT)
8682 error ("accumulator is not a constant integer");
8683 return NULL_RTX;
8685 if ((INTVAL (opval) & ~ACC_MASK) != 0)
8687 error ("accumulator number is out of bounds");
8688 return NULL_RTX;
8691 reg = gen_rtx_REG (insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].mode,
8692 ACC_FIRST + INTVAL (opval));
8693 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (reg, VOIDmode))
8694 SET_REGNO (reg, ACCG_FIRST + INTVAL (opval));
8696 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (reg, VOIDmode))
8698 error ("inappropriate accumulator for %qs", insn_data[icode].name);
8699 return NULL_RTX;
8701 return reg;
8704 /* If an ACC rtx has mode MODE, return the mode that the matching ACCG
8705 should have. */
8707 static enum machine_mode
8708 frv_matching_accg_mode (enum machine_mode mode)
8710 switch (mode)
8712 case V4SImode:
8713 return V4QImode;
8715 case DImode:
8716 return HImode;
8718 case SImode:
8719 return QImode;
8721 default:
8722 gcc_unreachable ();
8726 /* Given that a __builtin_read or __builtin_write function is accessing
8727 address ADDRESS, return the value that should be used as operand 1
8728 of the membar. */
8730 static rtx
8731 frv_io_address_cookie (rtx address)
8733 return (GET_CODE (address) == CONST_INT
8734 ? GEN_INT (INTVAL (address) / 8 * 8)
8735 : const0_rtx);
8738 /* Return the accumulator guard that should be paired with accumulator
8739 register ACC. The mode of the returned register is in the same
8740 class as ACC, but is four times smaller. */
8743 frv_matching_accg_for_acc (rtx acc)
8745 return gen_rtx_REG (frv_matching_accg_mode (GET_MODE (acc)),
8746 REGNO (acc) - ACC_FIRST + ACCG_FIRST);
8749 /* Read the requested argument from the call EXP given by INDEX.
8750 Return the value as an rtx. */
8752 static rtx
8753 frv_read_argument (tree exp, unsigned int index)
8755 return expand_normal (CALL_EXPR_ARG (exp, index));
8758 /* Like frv_read_argument, but interpret the argument as the number
8759 of an IACC register and return a (reg:MODE ...) rtx for it. */
8761 static rtx
8762 frv_read_iacc_argument (enum machine_mode mode, tree call,
8763 unsigned int index)
8765 int i, regno;
8766 rtx op;
8768 op = frv_read_argument (call, index);
8769 if (GET_CODE (op) != CONST_INT
8770 || INTVAL (op) < 0
8771 || INTVAL (op) > IACC_LAST - IACC_FIRST
8772 || ((INTVAL (op) * 4) & (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1)) != 0)
8774 error ("invalid IACC argument");
8775 op = const0_rtx;
8778 /* IACCs are implicit global registers. We set up this lazily to
8779 avoid creating lots of unnecessary call_insn rtl when IACCs aren't
8780 being used. */
8781 regno = INTVAL (op) + IACC_FIRST;
8782 for (i = 0; i < HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode); i++)
8783 global_regs[regno + i] = 1;
8785 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, regno);
8788 /* Return true if OPVAL can be used for operand OPNUM of instruction ICODE.
8789 The instruction should require a constant operand of some sort. The
8790 function prints an error if OPVAL is not valid. */
8792 static int
8793 frv_check_constant_argument (enum insn_code icode, int opnum, rtx opval)
8795 if (GET_CODE (opval) != CONST_INT)
8797 error ("%qs expects a constant argument", insn_data[icode].name);
8798 return FALSE;
8800 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (opval, VOIDmode))
8802 error ("constant argument out of range for %qs", insn_data[icode].name);
8803 return FALSE;
8805 return TRUE;
8808 /* Return a legitimate rtx for instruction ICODE's return value. Use TARGET
8809 if it's not null, has the right mode, and satisfies operand 0's
8810 predicate. */
8812 static rtx
8813 frv_legitimize_target (enum insn_code icode, rtx target)
8815 enum machine_mode mode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
8817 if (! target
8818 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
8819 || ! (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, mode))
8820 return gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8821 else
8822 return target;
8825 /* Given that ARG is being passed as operand OPNUM to instruction ICODE,
8826 check whether ARG satisfies the operand's constraints. If it doesn't,
8827 copy ARG to a temporary register and return that. Otherwise return ARG
8828 itself. */
8830 static rtx
8831 frv_legitimize_argument (enum insn_code icode, int opnum, rtx arg)
8833 enum machine_mode mode = insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].mode;
8835 if ((*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (arg, mode))
8836 return arg;
8837 else
8838 return copy_to_mode_reg (mode, arg);
8841 /* Return a volatile memory reference of mode MODE whose address is ARG. */
8843 static rtx
8844 frv_volatile_memref (enum machine_mode mode, rtx arg)
8846 rtx mem;
8848 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, memory_address (mode, arg));
8849 MEM_VOLATILE_P (mem) = 1;
8850 return mem;
8853 /* Expand builtins that take a single, constant argument. At the moment,
8854 only MHDSETS falls into this category. */
8856 static rtx
8857 frv_expand_set_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
8859 rtx pat;
8860 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8862 if (! frv_check_constant_argument (icode, 1, op0))
8863 return NULL_RTX;
8865 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8866 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0);
8867 if (! pat)
8868 return NULL_RTX;
8870 emit_insn (pat);
8871 return target;
8874 /* Expand builtins that take one operand. */
8876 static rtx
8877 frv_expand_unop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
8879 rtx pat;
8880 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8882 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8883 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8884 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0);
8885 if (! pat)
8886 return NULL_RTX;
8888 emit_insn (pat);
8889 return target;
8892 /* Expand builtins that take two operands. */
8894 static rtx
8895 frv_expand_binop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
8897 rtx pat;
8898 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8899 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
8901 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8902 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8903 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 2, op1);
8904 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
8905 if (! pat)
8906 return NULL_RTX;
8908 emit_insn (pat);
8909 return target;
8912 /* Expand cut-style builtins, which take two operands and an implicit ACCG
8913 one. */
8915 static rtx
8916 frv_expand_cut_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
8918 rtx pat;
8919 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8920 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
8921 rtx op2;
8923 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8924 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 1, op0);
8925 if (! op0)
8926 return NULL_RTX;
8928 if (icode == CODE_FOR_mdcutssi || GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
8930 if (! frv_check_constant_argument (icode, 2, op1))
8931 return NULL_RTX;
8933 else
8934 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 2, op1);
8936 op2 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op0);
8937 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1, op2);
8938 if (! pat)
8939 return NULL_RTX;
8941 emit_insn (pat);
8942 return target;
8945 /* Expand builtins that take two operands and the second is immediate. */
8947 static rtx
8948 frv_expand_binopimm_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
8950 rtx pat;
8951 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8952 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
8954 if (! frv_check_constant_argument (icode, 2, op1))
8955 return NULL_RTX;
8957 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8958 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8959 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
8960 if (! pat)
8961 return NULL_RTX;
8963 emit_insn (pat);
8964 return target;
8967 /* Expand builtins that take two operands, the first operand being a pointer to
8968 ints and return void. */
8970 static rtx
8971 frv_expand_voidbinop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
8973 rtx pat;
8974 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8975 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
8976 enum machine_mode mode0 = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
8977 rtx addr;
8979 if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM)
8981 rtx reg = op0;
8983 if (! offsettable_address_p (0, mode0, op0))
8985 reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
8986 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, op0));
8989 op0 = gen_rtx_MEM (SImode, reg);
8992 addr = XEXP (op0, 0);
8993 if (! offsettable_address_p (0, mode0, addr))
8994 addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, op0);
8996 op0 = change_address (op0, V4SImode, addr);
8997 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
8998 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1);
8999 if (! pat)
9000 return 0;
9002 emit_insn (pat);
9003 return 0;
9006 /* Expand builtins that take two long operands and return void. */
9008 static rtx
9009 frv_expand_int_void2arg (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
9011 rtx pat;
9012 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9013 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
9015 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
9016 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
9017 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1);
9018 if (! pat)
9019 return NULL_RTX;
9021 emit_insn (pat);
9022 return NULL_RTX;
9025 /* Expand prefetch builtins. These take a single address as argument. */
9027 static rtx
9028 frv_expand_prefetches (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
9030 rtx pat;
9031 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9033 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (force_reg (Pmode, op0));
9034 if (! pat)
9035 return 0;
9037 emit_insn (pat);
9038 return 0;
9041 /* Expand builtins that take three operands and return void. The first
9042 argument must be a constant that describes a pair or quad accumulators. A
9043 fourth argument is created that is the accumulator guard register that
9044 corresponds to the accumulator. */
9046 static rtx
9047 frv_expand_voidtriop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
9049 rtx pat;
9050 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9051 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
9052 rtx op2 = frv_read_argument (call, 2);
9053 rtx op3;
9055 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
9056 if (! op0)
9057 return NULL_RTX;
9059 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
9060 op2 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 2, op2);
9061 op3 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op0);
9062 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1, op2, op3);
9063 if (! pat)
9064 return NULL_RTX;
9066 emit_insn (pat);
9067 return NULL_RTX;
9070 /* Expand builtins that perform accumulator-to-accumulator operations.
9071 These builtins take two accumulator numbers as argument and return
9072 void. */
9074 static rtx
9075 frv_expand_voidaccop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
9077 rtx pat;
9078 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9079 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
9080 rtx op2;
9081 rtx op3;
9083 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
9084 if (! op0)
9085 return NULL_RTX;
9087 op1 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 1, op1);
9088 if (! op1)
9089 return NULL_RTX;
9091 op2 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op0);
9092 op3 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op1);
9093 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1, op2, op3);
9094 if (! pat)
9095 return NULL_RTX;
9097 emit_insn (pat);
9098 return NULL_RTX;
9101 /* Expand a __builtin_read* function. ICODE is the instruction code for the
9102 membar and TARGET_MODE is the mode that the loaded value should have. */
9104 static rtx
9105 frv_expand_load_builtin (enum insn_code icode, enum machine_mode target_mode,
9106 tree call, rtx target)
9108 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9109 rtx cookie = frv_io_address_cookie (op0);
9111 if (target == 0 || !REG_P (target))
9112 target = gen_reg_rtx (target_mode);
9113 op0 = frv_volatile_memref (insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode, op0);
9114 convert_move (target, op0, 1);
9115 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (copy_rtx (op0), cookie, GEN_INT (FRV_IO_READ)));
9116 cfun->machine->has_membar_p = 1;
9117 return target;
9120 /* Likewise __builtin_write* functions. */
9122 static rtx
9123 frv_expand_store_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
9125 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9126 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
9127 rtx cookie = frv_io_address_cookie (op0);
9129 op0 = frv_volatile_memref (insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode, op0);
9130 convert_move (op0, force_reg (insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode, op1), 1);
9131 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (copy_rtx (op0), cookie, GEN_INT (FRV_IO_WRITE)));
9132 cfun->machine->has_membar_p = 1;
9133 return NULL_RTX;
9136 /* Expand the MDPACKH builtin. It takes four unsigned short arguments and
9137 each argument forms one word of the two double-word input registers.
9138 CALL is the tree for the call and TARGET, if nonnull, suggests a good place
9139 to put the return value. */
9141 static rtx
9142 frv_expand_mdpackh_builtin (tree call, rtx target)
9144 enum insn_code icode = CODE_FOR_mdpackh;
9145 rtx pat, op0, op1;
9146 rtx arg1 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9147 rtx arg2 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
9148 rtx arg3 = frv_read_argument (call, 2);
9149 rtx arg4 = frv_read_argument (call, 3);
9151 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
9152 op0 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
9153 op1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
9155 /* The high half of each word is not explicitly initialized, so indicate
9156 that the input operands are not live before this point. */
9157 emit_clobber (op0);
9158 emit_clobber (op1);
9160 /* Move each argument into the low half of its associated input word. */
9161 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op0, DImode, 2), arg1);
9162 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op0, DImode, 6), arg2);
9163 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op1, DImode, 2), arg3);
9164 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op1, DImode, 6), arg4);
9166 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
9167 if (! pat)
9168 return NULL_RTX;
9170 emit_insn (pat);
9171 return target;
9174 /* Expand the MCLRACC builtin. This builtin takes a single accumulator
9175 number as argument. */
9177 static rtx
9178 frv_expand_mclracc_builtin (tree call)
9180 enum insn_code icode = CODE_FOR_mclracc;
9181 rtx pat;
9182 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9184 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
9185 if (! op0)
9186 return NULL_RTX;
9188 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0);
9189 if (pat)
9190 emit_insn (pat);
9192 return NULL_RTX;
9195 /* Expand builtins that take no arguments. */
9197 static rtx
9198 frv_expand_noargs_builtin (enum insn_code icode)
9200 rtx pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (const0_rtx);
9201 if (pat)
9202 emit_insn (pat);
9204 return NULL_RTX;
9207 /* Expand MRDACC and MRDACCG. These builtins take a single accumulator
9208 number or accumulator guard number as argument and return an SI integer. */
9210 static rtx
9211 frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
9213 rtx pat;
9214 rtx target = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
9215 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9217 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 1, op0);
9218 if (! op0)
9219 return NULL_RTX;
9221 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0);
9222 if (! pat)
9223 return NULL_RTX;
9225 emit_insn (pat);
9226 return target;
9229 /* Expand MWTACC and MWTACCG. These builtins take an accumulator or
9230 accumulator guard as their first argument and an SImode value as their
9231 second. */
9233 static rtx
9234 frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
9236 rtx pat;
9237 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9238 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
9240 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
9241 if (! op0)
9242 return NULL_RTX;
9244 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
9245 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1);
9246 if (pat)
9247 emit_insn (pat);
9249 return NULL_RTX;
9252 /* Emit a move from SRC to DEST in SImode chunks. This can be used
9253 to move DImode values into and out of IACC0. */
9255 static void
9256 frv_split_iacc_move (rtx dest, rtx src)
9258 enum machine_mode inner;
9259 int i;
9261 inner = GET_MODE (dest);
9262 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (inner); i += GET_MODE_SIZE (SImode))
9263 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (SImode, dest, inner, i),
9264 simplify_gen_subreg (SImode, src, inner, i));
9267 /* Expand builtins. */
9269 static rtx
9270 frv_expand_builtin (tree exp,
9271 rtx target,
9272 rtx subtarget ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9273 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9274 int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9276 tree fndecl = TREE_OPERAND (CALL_EXPR_FN (exp), 0);
9277 unsigned fcode = (unsigned)DECL_FUNCTION_CODE (fndecl);
9278 unsigned i;
9279 struct builtin_description *d;
9281 if (fcode < FRV_BUILTIN_FIRST_NONMEDIA && !TARGET_MEDIA)
9283 error ("media functions are not available unless -mmedia is used");
9284 return NULL_RTX;
9287 switch (fcode)
9289 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP1:
9290 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP2:
9291 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDUNPACKH:
9292 case FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOHE:
9293 if (! TARGET_MEDIA_REV1)
9295 error ("this media function is only available on the fr500");
9296 return NULL_RTX;
9298 break;
9300 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACHS:
9301 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACXHS:
9302 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACXHS:
9303 case FRV_BUILTIN_MADDACCS:
9304 case FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBACCS:
9305 case FRV_BUILTIN_MASACCS:
9306 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDADDACCS:
9307 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDSUBACCS:
9308 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDASACCS:
9309 case FRV_BUILTIN_MABSHS:
9310 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDROTLI:
9311 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLHI:
9312 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLI:
9313 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDCUTSSI:
9314 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQSATHS:
9315 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOS:
9316 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOH:
9317 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIS:
9318 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIH:
9319 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETS:
9320 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETH:
9321 if (! TARGET_MEDIA_REV2)
9323 error ("this media function is only available on the fr400"
9324 " and fr550");
9325 return NULL_RTX;
9327 break;
9329 case FRV_BUILTIN_SMASS:
9330 case FRV_BUILTIN_SMSSS:
9331 case FRV_BUILTIN_SMU:
9332 case FRV_BUILTIN_ADDSS:
9333 case FRV_BUILTIN_SUBSS:
9334 case FRV_BUILTIN_SLASS:
9335 case FRV_BUILTIN_SCUTSS:
9336 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadll:
9337 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadl:
9338 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetll:
9339 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetl:
9340 if (!TARGET_FR405_BUILTINS)
9342 error ("this builtin function is only available"
9343 " on the fr405 and fr450");
9344 return NULL_RTX;
9346 break;
9348 case FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH:
9349 if (!TARGET_FR500_FR550_BUILTINS)
9351 error ("this builtin function is only available on the fr500"
9352 " and fr550");
9353 return NULL_RTX;
9355 break;
9357 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQLCLRHS:
9358 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQLMTHS:
9359 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQSLLHI:
9360 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQSRAHI:
9361 if (!TARGET_MEDIA_FR450)
9363 error ("this builtin function is only available on the fr450");
9364 return NULL_RTX;
9366 break;
9368 default:
9369 break;
9372 /* Expand unique builtins. */
9374 switch (fcode)
9376 case FRV_BUILTIN_MTRAP:
9377 return frv_expand_noargs_builtin (CODE_FOR_mtrap);
9379 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACC:
9380 return frv_expand_mclracc_builtin (exp);
9382 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACCA:
9383 if (TARGET_ACC_8)
9384 return frv_expand_noargs_builtin (CODE_FOR_mclracca8);
9385 else
9386 return frv_expand_noargs_builtin (CODE_FOR_mclracca4);
9388 case FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACC:
9389 return frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mrdacc, exp);
9391 case FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACCG:
9392 return frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mrdaccg, exp);
9394 case FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACC:
9395 return frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mwtacc, exp);
9397 case FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACCG:
9398 return frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mwtaccg, exp);
9400 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDPACKH:
9401 return frv_expand_mdpackh_builtin (exp, target);
9403 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadll:
9405 rtx src = frv_read_iacc_argument (DImode, exp, 0);
9406 if (target == 0 || !REG_P (target))
9407 target = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
9408 frv_split_iacc_move (target, src);
9409 return target;
9412 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadl:
9413 return frv_read_iacc_argument (SImode, exp, 0);
9415 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetll:
9417 rtx dest = frv_read_iacc_argument (DImode, exp, 0);
9418 rtx src = frv_read_argument (exp, 1);
9419 frv_split_iacc_move (dest, force_reg (DImode, src));
9420 return 0;
9423 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetl:
9425 rtx dest = frv_read_iacc_argument (SImode, exp, 0);
9426 rtx src = frv_read_argument (exp, 1);
9427 emit_move_insn (dest, force_reg (SImode, src));
9428 return 0;
9431 default:
9432 break;
9435 /* Expand groups of builtins. */
9437 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_set; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_set); i++, d++)
9438 if (d->code == fcode)
9439 return frv_expand_set_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
9441 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_1arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_1arg); i++, d++)
9442 if (d->code == fcode)
9443 return frv_expand_unop_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
9445 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_2arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_2arg); i++, d++)
9446 if (d->code == fcode)
9447 return frv_expand_binop_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
9449 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_cut; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_cut); i++, d++)
9450 if (d->code == fcode)
9451 return frv_expand_cut_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
9453 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_2argimm; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_2argimm); i++, d++)
9454 if (d->code == fcode)
9455 return frv_expand_binopimm_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
9457 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_void2arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_void2arg); i++, d++)
9458 if (d->code == fcode)
9459 return frv_expand_voidbinop_builtin (d->icode, exp);
9461 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_void3arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_void3arg); i++, d++)
9462 if (d->code == fcode)
9463 return frv_expand_voidtriop_builtin (d->icode, exp);
9465 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_voidacc; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_voidacc); i++, d++)
9466 if (d->code == fcode)
9467 return frv_expand_voidaccop_builtin (d->icode, exp);
9469 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_int_void2arg;
9470 i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_int_void2arg); i++, d++)
9471 if (d->code == fcode)
9472 return frv_expand_int_void2arg (d->icode, exp);
9474 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_prefetches;
9475 i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_prefetches); i++, d++)
9476 if (d->code == fcode)
9477 return frv_expand_prefetches (d->icode, exp);
9479 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_loads; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_loads); i++, d++)
9480 if (d->code == fcode)
9481 return frv_expand_load_builtin (d->icode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9482 exp, target);
9484 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_stores; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_stores); i++, d++)
9485 if (d->code == fcode)
9486 return frv_expand_store_builtin (d->icode, exp);
9488 return 0;
9491 static bool
9492 frv_in_small_data_p (const_tree decl)
9494 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
9495 const_tree section_name;
9497 /* Don't apply the -G flag to internal compiler structures. We
9498 should leave such structures in the main data section, partly
9499 for efficiency and partly because the size of some of them
9500 (such as C++ typeinfos) is not known until later. */
9501 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
9502 return false;
9504 /* If we already know which section the decl should be in, see if
9505 it's a small data section. */
9506 section_name = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
9507 if (section_name)
9509 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (section_name) == STRING_CST);
9510 if (frv_string_begins_with (section_name, ".sdata"))
9511 return true;
9512 if (frv_string_begins_with (section_name, ".sbss"))
9513 return true;
9514 return false;
9517 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl));
9518 if (size > 0 && size <= g_switch_value)
9519 return true;
9521 return false;
9524 static bool
9525 frv_rtx_costs (rtx x,
9526 int code ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9527 int outer_code ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9528 int opno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9529 int *total,
9530 bool speed ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9532 if (outer_code == MEM)
9534 /* Don't differentiate between memory addresses. All the ones
9535 we accept have equal cost. */
9536 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (0);
9537 return true;
9540 switch (code)
9542 case CONST_INT:
9543 /* Make 12-bit integers really cheap. */
9544 if (IN_RANGE (INTVAL (x), -2048, 2047))
9546 *total = 0;
9547 return true;
9549 /* Fall through. */
9551 case CONST:
9552 case LABEL_REF:
9553 case SYMBOL_REF:
9554 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9555 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
9556 return true;
9558 case PLUS:
9559 case MINUS:
9560 case AND:
9561 case IOR:
9562 case XOR:
9563 case ASHIFT:
9564 case ASHIFTRT:
9565 case LSHIFTRT:
9566 case NOT:
9567 case NEG:
9568 case COMPARE:
9569 if (GET_MODE (x) == SImode)
9570 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
9571 else if (GET_MODE (x) == DImode)
9572 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
9573 else
9574 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
9575 return true;
9577 case MULT:
9578 if (GET_MODE (x) == SImode)
9579 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
9580 else
9581 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (6); /* guess */
9582 return true;
9584 case DIV:
9585 case UDIV:
9586 case MOD:
9587 case UMOD:
9588 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (18);
9589 return true;
9591 case MEM:
9592 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
9593 return true;
9595 default:
9596 return false;
9600 static void
9601 frv_asm_out_constructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9603 switch_to_section (ctors_section);
9604 assemble_align (POINTER_SIZE);
9605 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
9607 int ok = frv_assemble_integer (symbol, POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT, 1);
9609 gcc_assert (ok);
9610 return;
9612 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.picptr\t", symbol);
9615 static void
9616 frv_asm_out_destructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9618 switch_to_section (dtors_section);
9619 assemble_align (POINTER_SIZE);
9620 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
9622 int ok = frv_assemble_integer (symbol, POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT, 1);
9624 gcc_assert (ok);
9625 return;
9627 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.picptr\t", symbol);
9630 /* Worker function for TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX. */
9632 static rtx
9633 frv_struct_value_rtx (tree fntype ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9634 int incoming ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9636 return gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM);
9639 #define TLS_BIAS (2048 - 16)
9641 /* This is called from dwarf2out.c via TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL.
9642 We need to emit DTP-relative relocations. */
9644 static void
9645 frv_output_dwarf_dtprel (FILE *file, int size, rtx x)
9647 gcc_assert (size == 4);
9648 fputs ("\t.picptr\ttlsmoff(", file);
9649 /* We want the unbiased TLS offset, so add the bias to the
9650 expression, such that the implicit biasing cancels out. */
9651 output_addr_const (file, plus_constant (Pmode, x, TLS_BIAS));
9652 fputs (")", file);
9655 #include "gt-frv.h"